










                         SENDMAILTM

              INSTALLATION AND OPERATION GUIDE

                        Eric Allman
                       Claus Assmann
                    Gregory Neil Shapiro
                      Proofpoint, Inc.


                 For Sendmail Version 8.18




     SendmailTM implements a  general  purpose  internetwork
mail  routing  facility  under the UNIX(R) operating system.
It is not tied to any one transport protocol -- its function
may be likened to a crossbar switch, relaying messages  from
one  domain  into another.  In the process, it can do a lim-
ited amount of message header editing  to  put  the  message
into  a format that is appropriate for the receiving domain.
All of this is done under the  control  of  a  configuration
file.

     Due  to  the  requirements of flexibility for sendmail,
the configuration file  can  seem  somewhat  unapproachable.
However,  there are only a few basic configurations for most
sites, for which standard configuration files have been sup-
plied.  Most other configurations can be built by  adjusting
an existing configuration file incrementally.

     Sendmail  is  based  on  RFC 821 (Simple Mail Transport
Protocol), RFC 822 (Internet Mail Headers Format),  RFC  974
(MX  routing),  RFC  1123  (Internet Host Requirements), RFC
1413 (Identification server), RFC 1652 (SMTP 8BITMIME Exten-
sion), RFC 1869 (SMTP Service Extensions),  RFC  1870  (SMTP
SIZE  Extension),  RFC  1891 (SMTP Delivery Status Notifica-
tions), RFC 1892 (Multipart/Report), RFC 1893 (Enhanced Mail
System Status Codes), RFC 1894  (Delivery  Status  Notifica-
tions),  RFC 1985 (SMTP Service Extension for Remote Message
Queue Starting), RFC 2033 (Local Message Transmission Proto-
col),  RFC  2034  (SMTP  Service  Extension  for   Returning
____________________
   DISCLAIMER: This documentation is under modification.
   Sendmail  is  a  trademark of Proofpoint, Inc.  US Patent
Numbers 6865671, 6986037.




Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide           SMM:08-1







SMM:08-2           Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


Enhanced  Error  Codes),  RFC 2045 (MIME), RFC 2476 (Message
Submission), RFC 2487 (SMTP  Service  Extension  for  Secure
SMTP over TLS), RFC 2554 (SMTP Service Extension for Authen-
tication),  RFC  2821  (Simple  Mail Transfer Protocol), RFC
2822 (Internet Message Format), RFC 2852  (Deliver  By  SMTP
Service  Extension),  RFC  2920  (SMTP Service Extension for
Command Pipelining), and RFC 7505 (A "Null  MX"  No  Service
Resource  Record for Domains That Accept No Mail).  However,
since sendmail is designed to work in a wider world, in many
cases it can be configured to exceed these protocols.  These
cases are described herein.

     Although sendmail is intended to run without  the  need
for monitoring, it has a number of features that may be used
to  monitor  or  adjust  the operation under unusual circum-
stances.  These features are described.

     Section one describes how to do a  basic  sendmail  in-
stallation.  Section two explains the day-to-day information
you should know to maintain your mail system.  If you have a
relatively  normal  site,  these two sections should contain
sufficient information for you to install sendmail and  keep
it  happy.  Section three has information regarding the com-
mand line arguments.  Section four describes some parameters
that may be  safely  tweaked.   Section  five  contains  the
nitty-gritty information about the configuration file.  This
section  is  for  masochists and people who must write their
own configuration file.  Section six describes configuration
that can be done at compile time.   The  appendixes  give  a
brief  but  detailed explanation of a number of features not
described in the rest of the paper.
































Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide           SMM:08-7


1.  BASIC INSTALLATION

        There are two basic steps  to  installing  sendmail.
   First,  you  have  to compile and install the binary.  If
   sendmail has already been ported to your operating system
   that should be simple.  Second, you must build a run-time
   configuration file.  This is a file that  sendmail  reads
   when  it  starts  up  that describes the mailers it knows
   about, how to parse addresses, how to rewrite the message
   header, and the settings of  various  options.   Although
   the configuration file can be quite complex, a configura-
   tion can usually be built using an M4-based configuration
   language.   Assuming  you have the standard sendmail dis-
   tribution, see cf/README for further information.

        The remainder of this section will describe the  in-
   stallation  of  sendmail  assuming you can use one of the
   existing configurations and that the  standard  installa-
   tion  parameters are acceptable.  All pathnames and exam-
   ples are given from the root  of  the  sendmail  subtree,
   normally  /usr/src/usr.sbin/sendmail on 4.4BSD-based sys-
   tems.

        Continue with the next section if you  need/want  to
   compile  sendmail yourself.  If you have a running binary
   already on your system, you should probably skip to  sec-
   tion 1.2.

   1.1.  Compiling Sendmail

           All  sendmail source is in the sendmail subdirec-
      tory.  To compile sendmail, "cd" into the sendmail di-
      rectory and type

          ./Build

      This will leave the binary in an  appropriately  named
      subdirectory, e.g., obj.BSD-OS.2.1.i386.  It works for
      multiple  object versions compiled out of the same di-
      rectory.

      1.1.1.  Tweaking the Build Invocation

              You can give parameters on the Build  command.
         In  most  cases  these are only used when the obj.*
         directory  is  first  created.   To  restart   from
         scratch, use -c.  These commands include:

         -L libdirs
              A list of directories to search for libraries.

         -I incdirs
              A  list  of  directories to search for include










SMM:08-8           Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


              files.

         -E envar=value
              Set an environment variable  to  an  indicated
              value before compiling.

         -c   Create a new obj.*  tree before running.

         -f siteconfig
              Read  the  indicated  site configuration file.
              If this parameter is not specified, Build  in-
              cludes    all    of    the    files    $BUILD-
              TOOLS/Site/site.$oscf.m4      and      $BUILD-
              TOOLS/Site/site.config.m4,  where  $BUILDTOOLS
              is normally ../devtools and $oscf is the  same
              name as used on the obj.*  directory.  See be-
              low  for  a description of the site configura-
              tion file.

         -S   Skip  auto-configuration.   Build  will  avoid
              auto-detecting  libraries if this is set.  All
              libraries and map definitions must  be  speci-
              fied in the site configuration file.

         Most  other  parameters are passed to the make pro-
         gram; for details see $BUILDTOOLS/README.

      1.1.2.  Creating a Site Configuration File

              See sendmail/README  for  various  compilation
         flags  that can be set, and devtools/README for de-
         tails how to set them.

      1.1.3.  Tweaking the Makefile

              Sendmail supports two  different  formats  for
         the  local  (on disk) version of databases, notably
         the aliases database.  At least one of these should
         be defined if at all possible.

         CDB       Constant DataBase (tinycdb).

         NDBM      The  ``new  DBM''  format,  available  on
                   nearly  all  systems  around today.  This
                   was the preferred format prior to 4.4BSD.
                   It allows such complex things as multiple
                   databases and closing  a  currently  open
                   database.

         NEWDB     The  Berkeley  DB  package.   If you have
                   this, use it.  It  allows  long  records,
                   multiple  open  databases, real in-memory
                   caching, and so forth.   You  can  define










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide           SMM:08-9


                   this in conjunction with NDBM; if you do,
                   old  alias databases are read, but when a
                   new database is created  it  will  be  in
                   NEWDB  format.   As  a nasty hack, if you
                   have NEWDB, NDBM, and NIS defined, and if
                   the alias file  name  includes  the  sub-
                   string  "/yp/", sendmail will create both
                   new and old versions of  the  alias  file
                   during  a  newalias command.  This is re-
                   quired  because  the  Sun  NIS/YP  system
                   reads  the DBM version of the alias file.
                   It's ugly as sin, but it works.

         If neither of these are defined, sendmail reads the
         alias file into memory on every  invocation.   This
         can  be slow and should be avoided.  There are also
         several methods for remote database access:

         LDAP      Lightweight Directory Access Protocol.

         NIS       Sun's Network Information Services  (for-
                   merly YP).

         NISPLUS   Sun's NIS+ services.

         NETINFO   NeXT's NetInfo service.

         HESIOD    Hesiod service (from Athena).

         Other  compilation  flags  are  set  in  conf.h and
         should be predefined for you unless you are porting
         to a new environment.  For more options  see  send-
         mail/README.

      1.1.4.  Compilation and installation

              After  making  the  local system configuration
         described above, You should be able to compile  and
         install the system.  The script "Build" is the best
         approach on most systems:

             ./Build

         This  will use uname(1) to create a custom Makefile
         for your environment.

              If you are installing in the standard  places,
         you should be able to install using

             ./Build install

         This  should  install  the  binary in /usr/sbin and
         create   links   from    /usr/bin/newaliases    and










SMM:08-10          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


         /usr/bin/mailq to /usr/sbin/sendmail.  On most sys-
         tems  it  will  also  format and install man pages.
         Notice: as of version 8.12 sendmail will no  longer
         be  installed  set-user-ID root by default.  If you
         really want to use the old method, you can  specify
         it as target:

             ./Build install-set-user-id


   1.2.  Configuration Files

           Sendmail  cannot  operate without a configuration
      file.  The configuration  defines  the  mail  delivery
      mechanisms  understood  at  this  site,  how to access
      them, how to forward email to remote mail systems, and
      a number of  tuning  parameters.   This  configuration
      file  is  detailed  in the later portion of this docu-
      ment.

           The sendmail configuration  can  be  daunting  at
      first.   The world is complex, and the mail configura-
      tion reflects  that.   The  distribution  includes  an
      m4-based configuration package that hides a lot of the
      complexity.  See cf/README for details.

           Our  configuration  files  are processed by m4 to
      facilitate local customization; the  directory  cf  of
      the   sendmail  distribution  directory  contains  the
      source files.  This directory contains several  subdi-
      rectories:

      cf        Both site-dependent and site-independent de-
                scriptions  of  hosts.  These can be literal
                host  names  (e.g.,  "ucbvax.mc")  when  the
                hosts  are gateways or more general descrip-
                tions (such as  "generic-solaris2.mc"  as  a
                general  description  of  an  SMTP-connected
                host running Solaris 2.x.  Files ending  .mc
                (``M4  Configuration'')  are  the  input de-
                scriptions; the output is in the correspond-
                ing .cf  file.   The  general  structure  of
                these files is described below.

      domain    Site-dependent    subdomain    descriptions.
                These are tied to the way your  organization
                wants  to  do  addressing.  For example, do-
                main/CS.Berkeley.EDU.m4 is  our  description
                for  hosts in the CS.Berkeley.EDU subdomain.
                These are referenced  using  the  DOMAIN  m4
                macro in the .mc file.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-11


      feature   Definitions  of  specific features that some
                particular host in  your  site  might  want.
                These  are  referenced  using the FEATURE m4
                macro.  An example  feature  is  use_cw_file
                (which    tells    sendmail   to   read   an
                /etc/mail/local-host-names file  on  startup
                to find the set of local names).

      hack      Local  hacks,  referenced  using the HACK m4
                macro.  Try to avoid these.   The  point  of
                having  them  here  is to make it clear that
                they smell.

      m4        Site-independent m4(1)  include  files  that
                have information common to all configuration
                files.   This  can  be thought of as a "#in-
                clude" directory.

      mailer    Definitions of mailers, referenced using the
                MAILER m4 macro.  The mailer types that  are
                known  in  this distribution are fax, local,
                smtp, uucp, and usenet.  For example, to in-
                clude support for  the  UUCP-based  mailers,
                use "MAILER(uucp)".

      ostype    Definitions   describing  various  operating
                system environments (such as the location of
                support files).  These are referenced  using
                the OSTYPE m4 macro.

      sh        Shell  files  used  by the m4 build process.
                You shouldn't have to mess with these.

      siteconfig
                Local UUCP connectivity  information.   This
                directory  has  been supplanted by the mail-
                ertable  feature;  any  new   configurations
                should  use  that  feature  to  do UUCP (and
                other) routing.  The use of  this  directory
                is deprecated.

           If you are in a new domain (e.g., a company), you
      will probably want to create a cf/domain file for your
      domain.   This consists primarily of relay definitions
      and features you want enabled site-wide: for  example,
      Berkeley's domain definition defines relays for BitNET
      and  UUCP.  These are specific to Berkeley, and should
      be  fully-qualified   internet-style   domain   names.
      Please  check  to make certain they are reasonable for
      your domain.

           Subdomains at Berkeley are  also  represented  in
      the  cf/domain  directory.   For  example,  the domain










SMM:08-12          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      CS.Berkeley.EDU is  the  Computer  Science  subdomain,
      EECS.Berkeley.EDU  is  the  Electrical Engineering and
      Computer Sciences subdomain, and  S2K.Berkeley.EDU  is
      the Sequoia 2000 subdomain.  You will probably have to
      add  an  entry to this directory to be appropriate for
      your domain.

           You will have to use or create .mc files  in  the
      cf/cf  subdirectory  for your hosts.  This is detailed
      in the cf/README file.

   1.3.  Details of Installation Files

           This subsection describes the files that comprise
      the sendmail installation.

      1.3.1.  /usr/sbin/sendmail

              The  binary  for  sendmail   is   located   in
         /usr/sbin[1].  It should be set-group-ID  smmsp  as
         described  in sendmail/SECURITY.  For security rea-
         sons, /, /usr, and /usr/sbin  should  be  owned  by
         root, mode 0755[2].

      1.3.2.  /etc/mail/sendmail.cf

              This  is the main configuration file for send-
         mail[3].   This  is one of the two non-library file
         names  compiled  into  sendmail[4],  the  other  is
         /etc/mail/submit.cf.


____________________
   [1]This is usually /usr/sbin on 4.4BSD and newer systems;
many  systems install it in /usr/lib.  I understand it is in
/usr/ucblib on System V Release 4.
   [2]Some  vendors  ship  them owned by bin; this creates a
security hole that is  not  actually  related  to  sendmail.
Other  important  directories  that  should have restrictive
ownerships  and  permissions  are  /bin,   /usr/bin,   /etc,
/etc/mail, /usr/etc, /lib, and /usr/lib.
   [3]Actually, the pathname varies depending on the operat-
ing system; /etc/mail is the preferred directory.  Some old-
er systems install it in /usr/lib/sendmail.cf, and I've also
seen it in /usr/ucblib.  If you want to move this file,  add
-D_PATH_SENDMAILCF=\"/file/name\" to the flags passed to the
C compiler.  Moving this file is not recommended: other pro-
grams and scripts know of this location.
   [4]The  system  libraries  can  reference other files; in
particular, system library subroutines that  sendmail  calls
probably reference /etc/passwd and /etc/resolv.conf.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-13


              The configuration file is normally created us-
         ing the distribution files described above.  If you
         have  a  particularly  unusual system configuration
         you may need to create a special version.  The for-
         mat of this file is detailed in later  sections  of
         this document.

      1.3.3.  /etc/mail/submit.cf

              This  is  the  configuration file for sendmail
         when it is used for  initial  mail  submission,  in
         which case it is also called ``Mail Submission Pro-
         gram'' (MSP) in contrast to ``Mail Transfer Agent''
         (MTA).   Starting  with version 8.12, sendmail uses
         one of two different configuration files  based  on
         its  operation  mode  (or  the new -A option).  For
         initial mail submission, i.e., if one  of  the  op-
         tions  -bm (default), -bs, or -t is specified, sub-
         mit.cf is used (if available), for other operations
         sendmail.cf is used.  Details can be found in send-
         mail/SECURITY.  submit.cf is shipped with  sendmail
         (in  cf/cf/)  and  is  installed  by  default.   If
         changes to the configuration need to be made, start
         with cf/cf/submit.mc and follow the instruction  in
         cf/README.

      1.3.4.  /usr/bin/newaliases

              The  newaliases  command should just be a link
         to sendmail:

             rm -f /usr/bin/newaliases
             ln -s /usr/sbin/sendmail /usr/bin/newaliases

         This can be installed in whatever search  path  you
         prefer for your system.

      1.3.5.  /usr/bin/hoststat

              The  hoststat command should just be a link to
         sendmail, in a fashion similar to newaliases.  This
         command lists the status of the last mail  transac-
         tion  with all remote hosts.  The -v flag will pre-
         vent the status display from being  truncated.   It
         functions  only when the HostStatusDirectory option
         is set.

      1.3.6.  /usr/bin/purgestat

              This command is also a link to  sendmail.   It
         flushes  expired  (Timeout.hoststatus)  information
         that is stored in the HostStatusDirectory tree.











SMM:08-14          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      1.3.7.  /var/spool/mqueue

              The directory /var/spool/mqueue should be cre-
         ated to hold the mail queue.  This directory should
         be mode 0700 and owned by root.

              The actual path of this directory  is  defined
         by  the  QueueDirectory  option  of the sendmail.cf
         file.  To use multiple queues, supply a value  end-
         ing     with    an    asterisk.     For    example,
         /var/spool/mqueue/qd* will use all of the  directo-
         ries  or  symbolic  links  to directories beginning
         with `qd' in /var/spool/mqueue  as  queue  directo-
         ries.   Do not change the queue directory structure
         while sendmail is running.

              If these directories  have  subdirectories  or
         symbolic links to directories named `qf', `df', and
         `xf',  then  these  will  be used for the different
         queue file types.  That  is,  the  data  files  are
         stored  in  the  `df'  subdirectory, the transcript
         files are stored in the `xf' subdirectory, and  all
         others are stored in the `qf' subdirectory.

              If shared memory support is compiled in, send-
         mail  stores  the  available  diskspace in a shared
         memory segment to make the values readily available
         to all children without incurring system  overhead.
         In  this  case,  only  the daemon updates the data;
         i.e., the sendmail daemon creates the shared memory
         segment and deletes it if it is terminated.  To use
         this, sendmail must have been compiled with support
         for shared memory (-DSM_CONF_SHM)  and  the  option
         SharedMemoryKey  must  be  set.  Notice: do not use
         the same key for sendmail invocations with  differ-
         ent queue directories or different queue group dec-
         larations.   Access  to  shared  memory is not con-
         trolled by locks, i.e., there is a  race  condition
         when  data  in  the shared memory is updated.  How-
         ever, since operation of sendmail does not rely  on
         the  data in the shared memory, this does not nega-
         tively influence the behavior.

      1.3.8.  /var/spool/clientmqueue

              The directory  /var/spool/clientmqueue  should
         be  created to hold the mail queue.  This directory
         should be mode 0770 and owned by user smmsp,  group
         smmsp.

              The  actual  path of this directory is defined
         by the QueueDirectory option of the submit.cf file.











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-15


      1.3.9.  /var/spool/mqueue/.hoststat

              This is a typical value for the  HostStatusDi-
         rectory  option,  containing one file per host that
         this sendmail has chatted  with  recently.   It  is
         normally a subdirectory of mqueue.

      1.3.10.  /etc/mail/aliases*

              The     system    aliases    are    held    in
         "/etc/mail/aliases".  A sample is given  in  "send-
         mail/aliases"  which  includes  some  aliases which
         must be defined:

             cp sendmail/aliases /etc/mail/aliases
             edit /etc/mail/aliases

         You should extend this file with any  aliases  that
         are apropos to your system.

              Normally  sendmail looks at a database version
         of     the     files,     stored     either      in
         "/etc/mail/aliases.dir" and "/etc/mail/aliases.pag"
         or  "/etc/mail/aliases.db" depending on which data-
         base package you are using.   The  actual  path  of
         this file is defined in the AliasFile option of the
         sendmail.cf file.

              The  permissions  of  the  alias  file and the
         database versions should be 0640 to  prevent  local
         denial  of  service attacks as explained in the top
         level README in the sendmail distribution.  If  the
         permissions  0640  are  used,  be  sure  that  only
         trusted users belong to the group assigned to those
         files.  Otherwise, files should not even  be  group
         readable.

      1.3.11.  /etc/rc or /etc/init.d/sendmail

              It  will be necessary to start up the sendmail
         daemon when your system reboots.  This daemon  per-
         forms  two functions: it listens on the SMTP socket
         for connections (to receive mail from a remote sys-
         tem) and it processes the queue periodically to in-
         sure that mail gets delivered when hosts come up.

              If  necessary,  add  the  following  lines  to
         "/etc/rc"  (or  "/etc/rc.local"  as appropriate) in
         the area where it is starting up the daemons  on  a
         BSD-base  system,  or on a System-V-based system in
         one    of    the    startup    files,     typically
         "/etc/init.d/sendmail":











SMM:08-16          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


             if [ -f /usr/sbin/sendmail -a -f /etc/mail/sendmail.cf ]; then
                  (cd /var/spool/mqueue; rm -f xf*)
                  /usr/sbin/sendmail -bd -q30m &
                  echo -n ' sendmail' >/dev/console
             fi

         The  "cd"  and  "rm" commands insure that all tran-
         script files have been  removed;  extraneous  tran-
         script  files may be left around if the system goes
         down in the middle of processing  a  message.   The
         line  that actually invokes sendmail has two flags:
         "-bd" causes it to listen on  the  SMTP  port,  and
         "-q30m" causes it to run the queue every half hour.

              Some people use a more complex startup script,
         removing  zero  length  qf/hf/Qf files and df files
         for which there is no qf/hf/Qf file.  Note this  is
         not  advisable.   For  example, see Figure 1 for an
         example of a complex script which does  this  clean
         up.

      1.3.12.  /etc/mail/helpfile

              This  is  the  help file used by the SMTP HELP
         command.  It should be copied from  "sendmail/help-
         file":

             cp sendmail/helpfile /etc/mail/helpfile

         The  actual  path  of  this  file is defined in the
         HelpFile option of the sendmail.cf file.

      1.3.13.  /etc/mail/statistics

              If you wish to collect statistics  about  your
         mail   traffic,   you   should   create   the  file
         "/etc/mail/statistics":

             cp /dev/null /etc/mail/statistics
             chmod 0600 /etc/mail/statistics

         This file does not grow.  It is  printed  with  the
         program  "mailstats/mailstats.c."   The actual path
         of this file is defined in  the  S  option  of  the
         sendmail.cf file.

      1.3.14.  /usr/bin/mailq

              If  sendmail  is  invoked  as "mailq," it will
         simulate the -bp flag (i.e.,  sendmail  will  print
         the  contents  of the mail queue; see below).  This
         should be a link to /usr/sbin/sendmail.











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-17



____________________________________________________________

#!/bin/sh
# remove zero length qf/hf/Qf files
for qffile in qf* hf* Qf*
do
     if [ -r $qffile ]
     then
          if [ ! -s $qffile ]
          then
               echo -n " <zero: $qffile>" > /dev/console
               rm -f $qffile
          fi
     fi
done
# rename tf files to be qf if the qf does not exist
for tffile in tf*
do
     qffile=`echo $tffile | sed 's/t/q/'`
     if [ -r $tffile -a ! -f $qffile ]
     then
          echo -n " <recovering: $tffile>" > /dev/console
          mv $tffile $qffile
     else
          if [ -f $tffile ]
          then
               echo -n " <extra: $tffile>" > /dev/console
               rm -f $tffile
          fi
     fi
done
# remove df files with no corresponding qf/hf/Qf files
for dffile in df*
do
     qffile=`echo $dffile | sed 's/d/q/'`
     hffile=`echo $dffile | sed 's/d/h/'`
     Qffile=`echo $dffile | sed 's/d/Q/'`
     if [ -r $dffile -a ! -f $qffile -a ! -f $hffile -a ! -f $Qffile ]
     then
          echo -n " <incomplete: $dffile>" > /dev/console
          mv $dffile `echo $dffile | sed 's/d/D/'`
     fi
done
# announce files that have been saved during disaster recovery
for xffile in [A-Z]f*
do
     if [ -f $xffile ]
     then
          echo -n " <panic: $xffile>" > /dev/console
     fi
done











SMM:08-18          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


            Figure 1 -- A complex startup script
____________________________________________________________


      1.3.15.  sendmail.pid

              sendmail stores its current pid  in  the  file
         specified   by   the  PidFile  option  (default  is
         _PATH_SENDMAILPID).   sendmail  uses   TempFileMode
         (which defaults to 0600) as the permissions of that
         file  to prevent local denial of service attacks as
         explained in the top level README in  the  sendmail
         distribution.   If the file already exists, then it
         might be necessary to change  the  permissions  ac-
         cordingly, e.g.,

             chmod 0600 /var/run/sendmail.pid

         Note that as of version 8.13, this file is unlinked
         when sendmail exits.  As a result of this change, a
         script such as the following, which may have worked
         prior to 8.13, will no longer work:

             # stop & start sendmail
             PIDFILE=/var/run/sendmail.pid
             kill `head -1 $PIDFILE`
             `tail -1 $PIDFILE`

         because  it assumes that the pidfile will still ex-
         ist even after killing  the  process  to  which  it
         refers.   Below  is  a  script which will work cor-
         rectly on both newer and older versions:

             # stop & start sendmail
             PIDFILE=/var/run/sendmail.pid
             pid=`head -1 $PIDFILE`
             cmd=`tail -1 $PIDFILE`
             kill $pid
             $cmd

         This is just an example script, it does not perform
         any error checks, e.g., whether the pidfile  exists
         at all.

      1.3.16.  Map Files

              To  prevent local denial of service attacks as
         explained in the top level README in  the  sendmail
         distribution,  the permissions of map files created
         by makemap should be 0640.  The use of 0640 implies
         that only trusted users belong  to  the  group  as-
         signed  to those files.  If those files already ex-
         ist, then it  might  be  necessary  to  change  the










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-19


         permissions accordingly, e.g.,

             cd /etc/mail
             chmod 0640 *.db *.pag *.dir


2.  NORMAL OPERATIONS

   2.1.  The System Log

           The  system  log  is  supported by the syslogd(8)
      program.  All messages from sendmail are logged  under
      the LOG_MAIL facility[5].

      2.1.1.  Format

              Each  line  in  the  system  log consists of a
         timestamp, the name of the machine  that  generated
         it  (for logging from several machines over the lo-
         cal area network), the word "sendmail:", and a mes-
         sage[6].    Most   messages   are   a  sequence  of
         name=value pairs.

              The two most common lines are  logged  when  a
         message  is  processed.  The first logs the receipt
         of a message; there will be exactly  one  of  these
         per message.  Some fields may be omitted if they do
         not contain interesting information.  Fields are:

         from      The envelope sender address.

         size      The size of the message in bytes.

         class     The  class  (i.e., numeric precedence) of
                   the message.

         pri       The initial message  priority  (used  for
                   queue sorting).

         nrcpts    The  number  of  envelope  recipients for
                   this message (after aliasing and forward-
                   ing).

         msgid     The message id of the message  (from  the
                   header).

____________________
   [5]Except on Ultrix, which does not support facilities in
the syslog.
   [6]This format may  vary  slightly  if  your  vendor  has
changed the syntax.












SMM:08-20          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


         bodytype  The message body type (7BIT or 8BITMIME),
                   as determined from the envelope.

         proto     The protocol used to receive this message
                   (e.g., ESMTP or UUCP)

         daemon    The  daemon  name  from the DaemonPortOp-
                   tions setting.

         relay     The machine from which it was received.

         There is also one line logged per delivery  attempt
         (so there can be several per message if delivery is
         deferred or there are multiple recipients).  Fields
         are:

         to        A  comma-separated list of the recipients
                   to this mailer.

         ctladdr   The ``controlling user'',  that  is,  the
                   name of the user whose credentials we use
                   for delivery.

         delay     The  total  delay  between  the time this
                   message was received and the current  de-
                   livery attempt.

         xdelay    The  amount of time needed in this deliv-
                   ery attempt (normally indicative  of  the
                   speed of the connection).

         mailer    The name of the mailer used to deliver to
                   this recipient.

         relay     The  name  of  the host that actually ac-
                   cepted (or rejected) this recipient.

         dsn       The enhanced error  code  (RFC  2034)  if
                   available.

         stat      The delivery status.

         Not all fields are present in all messages; for ex-
         ample,  the  relay  is usually not listed for local
         deliveries.

      2.1.2.  Levels

              If you have syslogd(8) or  an  equivalent  in-
         stalled,  you will be able to do logging.  There is
         a large amount of information that can  be  logged.
         The  log is arranged as a succession of levels.  At
         the lowest level only extremely strange  situations










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-21


         are  logged.   At  the highest level, even the most
         mundane and uninteresting events are  recorded  for
         posterity.   As  a convention, log levels under ten
         are considered generally "useful;" log levels above
         64 are reserved  for  debugging  purposes.   Levels
         from  11-64  are  reserved  for verbose information
         that some sites might want.

              A complete description of the  log  levels  is
         given in section ``Log Level''.

   2.2.  Dumping State

           You  can  ask  sendmail to log a dump of the open
      files and the connection cache by sending it a SIGUSR1
      signal.  The results are logged at LOG_DEBUG priority.

   2.3.  The Mail Queues

           Mail messages may either be delivered immediately
      or be held for  later  delivery.   Held  messages  are
      placed into a holding directory called a mail queue.

           A mail message may be queued for these reasons:

       + If  a mail message is temporarily undeliverable, it
         is queued and delivery is attempted later.  If  the
         message  is addressed to multiple recipients, it is
         queued only for those recipients to  whom  delivery
         is not immediately possible.
       + If  the  SuperSafe  option is set to true, all mail
         messages are queued while delivery is attempted.
       + If the DeliveryMode option is set to queue-only  or
         defer,  all mail is queued, and no immediate deliv-
         ery is attempted.
       + If the load average becomes higher than  the  value
         of  the  QueueLA option and the QueueFactor (q) op-
         tion divided by the difference in the current  load
         average  and  the  QueueLA  option plus one is less
         than the priority  of  the  message,  messages  are
         queued rather than immediately delivered.
       + One  or  more addresses are marked as expensive and
         delivery is postponed until the next queue  run  or
         one  or  more address are marked as held via mailer
         which uses the hold mailer flag.
       + The mail message has been marked as quarantined via
         a mail filter or rulesets.

      2.3.1.  Queue Groups and Queue Directories

              There are one or more mail queues.  Each  mail
         queue  belongs to a queue group.  There is always a
         default  queue  group  that  is  called  ``mqueue''










SMM:08-22          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


         (which  is where messages go by default unless oth-
         erwise specified).  The  directory  or  directories
         which  comprise  the default queue group are speci-
         fied by the QueueDirectory option.  There are  zero
         or  more additional named queue groups declared us-
         ing the Q command in the configuration file.

              By default, a queued message is placed in  the
         queue  group associated with the first recipient in
         the recipient list.  A recipient address is  mapped
         to  a queue group as follows.  First, if there is a
         ruleset called ``queuegroup'', and if this  ruleset
         maps  the  address to a queue group name, then that
         queue group is chosen.  That is, the  argument  for
         the ruleset is the recipient address (i.e., the ad-
         dress  part  of the resolved triple) and the result
         should be $# followed by the name of a queue group.
         Otherwise, if the mailer associated  with  the  ad-
         dress  specifies  a  queue  group,  then that queue
         group is  chosen.   Otherwise,  the  default  queue
         group is chosen.

              A  message  with  multiple  recipients will be
         split if different queue groups are chosen  by  the
         mapping of recipients to queue groups.

              When a message is placed in a queue group, and
         the queue group has more than one queue, a queue is
         selected randomly.

              If  a  message  with  multiple  recipients  is
         placed into a queue group with the 'r' option (max-
         imum number of recipients per  message)  set  to  a
         positive  value N, and if there are more than N re-
         cipients in the message, then the message  will  be
         split into multiple messages, each of which have at
         most N recipients.

              Notice:  if multiple queue groups are used, do
         not move queue files around, e.g., into a different
         queue directory.  This may have weird  effects  and
         can  cause  mail  not to be delivered.  Queue files
         and directories should be  treated  as  opaque  and
         should not be manipulated directly.

      2.3.2.  Queue Runs

              sendmail has two different ways to process the
         queue(s).   The first one is to start queue runners
         after certain intervals (``normal'' queue runners),
         the second one is to keep  queue  runner  processes
         around  (``persistent'' queue runners).  How to se-
         lect either of these  types  is  discussed  in  the










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-23


         appendix  ``COMMAND LINE FLAGS''.  Persistent queue
         runners have the advantage that  no  new  processes
         need  to be spawned at certain intervals; they just
         sleep for a specified time after  they  finished  a
         queue  run.   Another advantage of persistent queue
         runners is that only one  process  belonging  to  a
         workgroup  (a  workgroup  is a set of queue groups)
         collects the data for a queue run and then multiple
         queue runner may go ahead using  that  data.   This
         can  significantly reduce the disk I/O necessary to
         read the queue files compared to starting  multiple
         queue runners directly.  Their disadvantage is that
         a  new  queue  run  is only started after all queue
         runners belonging to a group finished their  tasks.
         In  case one of the queue runners tries delivery to
         a slow recipient site at the end of  a  queue  run,
         the  next  queue  run may be substantially delayed.
         In general this should be smoothed out due  to  the
         distribution of those slow jobs, however, for sites
         with  small  number of queue entries this might in-
         troduce noticeable delays.  In general,  persistent
         queue  runners  are  only useful for sites with big
         queues.

      2.3.3.  Manual Intervention

              Under normal conditions the mail queue will be
         processed transparently.   However,  you  may  find
         that  manual  intervention  is sometimes necessary.
         For example, if a major host is down for  a  period
         of  time  the  queue  may become clogged.  Although
         sendmail ought to recover gracefully when the  host
         comes up, you may find performance unacceptably bad
         in  the  meantime.   In that case you want to check
         the content of the queue and manipulate it  as  ex-
         plained in the next two sections.

      2.3.4.  Printing the queue

              The  contents  of  the queue(s) can be printed
         using the mailq command (or by specifying  the  -bp
         flag to sendmail):

             mailq

         This  will produce a listing of the queue id's, the
         size of the message, the date the  message  entered
         the  queue,  and  the  sender  and  recipients.  If
         shared memory support is compiled in, the flag  -bP
         can  be  used to print the number of entries in the
         queue(s), provided  a  process  updates  the  data.
         However,  as explained earlier, the output might be
         slightly wrong, since access to the  shared  memory










SMM:08-24          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


         is  not  locked.   For example, ``unknown number of
         entries'' might be shown.   The  internal  counters
         are  updated  after  each  queue run to the correct
         value again.

      2.3.5.  Forcing the queue

              Sendmail should run the queue automatically at
         intervals.  When using multiple queues, a  separate
         process  will  by default be created to run each of
         the queues unless the queue run is initiated  by  a
         user  with  the  verbose flag.  The algorithm is to
         read and sort the queue, and  then  to  attempt  to
         process all jobs in order.  When it attempts to run
         the job, sendmail first checks to see if the job is
         locked.  If so, it ignores the job.

              There  is  no  attempt to insure that only one
         queue processor exists at any time, since there  is
         no  guarantee  that  a  job  cannot take forever to
         process (however, sendmail does include  heuristics
         to try to abort jobs that are taking absurd amounts
         of time; technically, this violates RFC 821, but is
         blessed  by  RFC  1123).   Due to the locking algo-
         rithm, it is impossible for one job to  freeze  the
         entire  queue.  However, an uncooperative recipient
         host or a program recipient that never returns  can
         accumulate many processes in your system.  Unfortu-
         nately, there is no completely general way to solve
         this.

              In  some cases, you may find that a major host
         going down for a couple of days may create  a  pro-
         hibitively  large queue.  This will result in send-
         mail spending an inordinate amount of time  sorting
         the  queue.   This situation can be fixed by moving
         the queue to a temporary place and creating  a  new
         queue.  The old queue can be run later when the of-
         fending host returns to service.

              To  do  this, it is acceptable to move the en-
         tire queue directory:

             cd /var/spool
             mv mqueue omqueue; mkdir mqueue; chmod 0700 mqueue

         You should then kill the existing daemon (since  it
         will  still  be  processing in the old queue direc-
         tory) and create a new daemon.

              To run the old mail queue, issue the following
         command:











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-25


             /usr/sbin/sendmail -C /etc/mail/queue.cf -q

         The -C flag specifies  an  alternate  configuration
         file queue.cf which should refer to the moved queue
         directory

             O QueueDirectory=/var/spool/omqueue

         and  the  -q flag says to just run every job in the
         queue.  You can also specify the moved queue direc-
         tory on the command line

             /usr/sbin/sendmail -oQ/var/spool/omqueue -q

         but this requires that you do not have queue groups
         in the configuration file, because  those  are  not
         subdirectories  of  the  moved  directory.  See the
         section about ``Queue Group Declaration''  for  de-
         tails;  you most likely need a different configura-
         tion file to  correctly  deal  with  this  problem.
         However,  a  proper  configuration  of queue groups
         should avoid filling up queue directories,  so  you
         shouldn't  run  into  this  problem.  If you have a
         tendency toward voyeurism, you can use the -v  flag
         to watch what is going on.

              When the queue is finally emptied, you can re-
         move the directory:

             rmdir /var/spool/omqueue


      2.3.6.  Quarantined Queue Items

              It  is possible to "quarantine" mail messages,
         otherwise known  as  envelopes.   Envelopes  (queue
         files)  are  stored but not considered for delivery
         or display unless the "quarantine" state of the en-
         velope is undone or delivery or display of  quaran-
         tined items is requested.  Quarantined messages are
         tagged  by  using  a  different  name for the queue
         file, 'hf' instead of 'qf', and by adding the quar-
         antine reason to the queue file.

              Delivery or display of quarantined  items  can
         be  requested  using  the  -qQ  flag to sendmail or
         mailq.  Additionally, messages already in the queue
         can be quarantined or unquarantined using  the  new
         -Q flag to sendmail.  For example,

             sendmail -Qreason -q[!][I|R|S][matchstring]

         Quarantines  the  normal  queue  items matching the










SMM:08-26          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


         criteria specified by the -q[!][I|R|S][matchstring]
         using the reason given on the -Q flag.  Likewise,

             sendmail -qQ -Q[reason] -q[!][I|R|S|Q][matchstring]

         Change the quarantine reason  for  the  quarantined
         items   matching  the  criteria  specified  by  the
         -q[!][I|R|S|Q][matchstring] using the reason  given
         on the -Q flag.  If there is no reason,
          unquarantine the matching items and make them nor-
         mal  queue  items.   Note  that  the -qQ flag tells
         sendmail to operate on quarantined items instead of
         normal items.

   2.4.  Disk Based Connection Information

           Sendmail stores a  large  amount  of  information
      about  each  remote system it has connected to in mem-
      ory. It is possible to preserve some of this  informa-
      tion on disk as well, by using the HostStatusDirectory
      option, so that it may be shared between several invo-
      cations  of  sendmail.   This allows mail to be queued
      immediately or skipped during a queue run if there has
      been a recent failure in connecting to  a  remote  ma-
      chine.   Note:  information  about  a remote system is
      stored in a file whose pathname consists of the compo-
      nents of the hostname in reverse order.  For  example,
      the  information  for  host.example.com  is  stored in
      com./example./host.  For top-level  domains  like  com
      this can create a large number of subdirectories which
      on  some  filesystems  can exhaust some limits.  More-
      over, the performance of  lookups  in  directory  with
      thousands  of  entries can be fairly slow depending on
      the filesystem implementation.

           Additionally  enabling  SingleThreadDelivery  has
      the  added effect of single-threading mail delivery to
      a destination.  This can be quite helpful if  the  re-
      mote  machine is running an SMTP server that is easily
      overloaded or cannot accept more than a single connec-
      tion at a time, but can  cause  some  messages  to  be
      punted  to a future queue run.  It also applies to all
      hosts, so setting this because you have one machine on
      site that runs some software that  is  easily  overrun
      can  cause  mail to other hosts to be slowed down.  If
      this option is set, you probably want to set the  Min-
      QueueAge  option as well and run the queue fairly fre-
      quently; this way jobs that are  skipped  because  an-
      other  sendmail  is  talking  to the same host will be
      tried again quickly rather than being  delayed  for  a
      long time.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-27


           The  disk  based  host information is stored in a
      subdirectory of the  mqueue  directory  called  .host-
      stat[7].  Removing this directory and its  subdirecto-
      ries  has  an  effect similar to the purgestat command
      and is completely safe.  However, purgestat  only  re-
      moves expired (Timeout.hoststatus) data.  The informa-
      tion  in  these  directories  can  be perused with the
      hoststat command, which will indicate the  host  name,
      the  last  access,  and the status of that access.  An
      asterisk in the left  most  column  indicates  that  a
      sendmail  process  currently  has  the host locked for
      mail delivery.

           The disk based connection information is  treated
      the  same  way  as memory based connection information
      for the purpose of timeouts.  By default,  information
      about host failures is valid for 30 minutes.  This can
      be adjusted with the Timeout.hoststatus option.

           The  connection information stored on disk may be
      expired at any time with the purgestat command  or  by
      invoking sendmail with the -bH switch.  The connection
      information may be viewed with the hoststat command or
      by invoking sendmail with the -bh switch.

   2.5.  The Service Switch

           The  implementation  of  certain  system services
      such as host and user name lookup is controlled by the
      service switch.  If the host operating system supports
      such a switch, and sendmail knows about  it,  sendmail
      will use the native version.  Ultrix, Solaris, and DEC
      OSF/1 are examples of such systems[8].

           If  the underlying operating system does not sup-
      port a service switch (e.g., SunOS  4.X,  HP-UX,  BSD)
      then sendmail will provide a stub implementation.  The
      ServiceSwitchFile  option points to the name of a file
      that has the service definitions.  Each line  has  the
      name  of a service and the possible implementations of
      that service.  For example, the file:

          hosts     dns files nis
          aliases   files nis
____________________
   [7]This is the usual value of the HostStatusDirectory op-
tion;  it  can,  of  course,  go  anywhere  you like in your
filesystem.
   [8]HP-UX  10  has  service  switch support, but since the
APIs are apparently not available in the libraries  sendmail
does not use the native service switch in this release.












SMM:08-28          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      will ask sendmail to look for hosts in the Domain Name
      System first.  If  the  requested  host  name  is  not
      found,  it  tries  local  files,  and if that fails it
      tries NIS.  Similarly, when  looking  for  aliases  it
      will try the local files first followed by NIS.

           Notice: since sendmail must access MX records for
      correct operation, it will use DNS if it is configured
      in the ServiceSwitchFile file.  Hence an entry like

          hosts     files dns

      will not avoid DNS lookups even if a host can be found
      in /etc/hosts.

           Note:  in contrast to the sendmail stub implemen-
      tation some operating systems do not  preserve  tempo-
      rary   failures.    For  example,  if  DNS  returns  a
      TRY_AGAIN status for this setup

          hosts     files dns myhostname

      but myhostname does not find the requested entry, then
      a permanent error is returned to sendmail which  obvi-
      ously  can  cause  problems, e.g., an immediate bounce
      instead of a deferral.

           Service switches are not  completely  integrated.
      For  example,  despite  the  fact  that the host entry
      listed in the above example specifies to look in  NIS,
      on  SunOS  this won't happen because the system imple-
      mentation of gethostbyname(3) doesn't understand this.

   2.6.  The Alias Database

           After recipient addresses are read from the  SMTP
      connection  or command line they are parsed by ruleset
      0, which must resolve to  a  {mailer,  host,  address}
      triple.   If  the flags selected by the mailer include
      the A (aliasable) flag, the address part of the triple
      is looked up as the key (i.e., the left hand side)  in
      the  alias database.  If there is a match, the address
      is deleted from the send queue and  all  addresses  on
      the right hand side of the alias are added in place of
      the  alias that was found.  This is a recursive opera-
      tion, so aliases found in the right hand side  of  the
      alias are similarly expanded.

           The alias database exists in two forms.  One is a
      text  form,  maintained in the file /etc/mail/aliases.
      The aliases are of the form

          name: name1, name2, ...










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-29


      Only local names may be aliased; e.g.,

          eric@prep.ai.MIT.EDU: eric@CS.Berkeley.EDU

      will  not  have  the   desired   effect   (except   on
      prep.ai.MIT.EDU,  and they probably don't want me)[9].
      Aliases may be continued by starting any  continuation
      lines  with a space or a tab or by putting a backslash
      directly before the newline.  Blank  lines  and  lines
      beginning with a sharp sign ("#") are comments.

           The second form is processed by one of the avail-
      able  map types, e.g., ndbm(3)[10] the Berkeley DB li-
      brary, or cdb.  This is the form that  sendmail  actu-
      ally  uses to resolve aliases.  This technique is used
      to improve performance.

           The control of search order is  actually  set  by
      the service switch.  Essentially, the entry

          O AliasFile=switch:aliases

      is  always  added  as the first alias entry; also, the
      first alias file name without a class  (e.g.,  without
      "nis:"  on  the front) will be used as the name of the
      file for a ``files'' entry in the aliases switch.  For
      example, if the configuration file contains

          O AliasFile=/etc/mail/aliases

      and the service switch contains

          aliases   nis files nisplus

      then aliases will first be searched in the  NIS  data-
      base,  then  in  /etc/mail/aliases,  then  in the NIS+
      database.

           You can also use NIS-based alias files.  For  ex-
      ample, the specification:

          O AliasFile=/etc/mail/aliases
          O AliasFile=nis:mail.aliases@my.nis.domain

      will  first search the /etc/mail/aliases file and then
      the  map  named  "mail.aliases"  in   "my.nis.domain".
____________________
   [9]Actually,  any mailer that has the `A' mailer flag set
will permit aliasing; this is normally limited to the  local
mailer.
   [10]The gdbm package does not work.












SMM:08-30          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      Warning:  if you build your own NIS-based alias files,
      be sure to provide the -l flag to  makedbm(8)  to  map
      upper  case  letters in the keys to lower case; other-
      wise, aliases with upper case letters in  their  names
      won't match incoming addresses.

           Additional flags can be added after the colon ex-
      actly like a K line -- for example:

          O AliasFile=nis:-N mail.aliases@my.nis.domain

      will search the appropriate NIS map and always include
      null bytes in the key.  Also:

          O AliasFile=nis:-f mail.aliases@my.nis.domain

      will  prevent  sendmail from downcasing the key before
      the alias lookup.

      2.6.1.  Rebuilding the alias database

              The hash or dbm version of the database may be
         rebuilt explicitly by executing the command

             newaliases

         This is equivalent to giving sendmail the -bi flag:

             /usr/sbin/sendmail -bi


              If you have multiple aliases databases  speci-
         fied,  the -bi flag rebuilds all the database types
         it understands (for example, it  can  rebuild  NDBM
         databases but not NIS databases).

      2.6.2.  Potential problems

              There  are a number of problems that can occur
         with the alias database.  They all  result  from  a
         sendmail process accessing the DBM version while it
         is only partially built.  This can happen under two
         circumstances:  One  process  accesses the database
         while another process  is  rebuilding  it,  or  the
         process  rebuilding the database dies (due to being
         killed or a system crash) before completing the re-
         build.

              Sendmail has three techniques to  try  to  re-
         lieve these problems.  First, it ignores interrupts
         while  rebuilding  the  database;  this  avoids the
         problem of someone aborting the process  leaving  a
         partially  rebuilt  database.  Second, it locks the










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-31


         database source file during the rebuild -- but that
         may not work over NFS or if the file is unwritable.
         Third, at the end of the rebuild it adds  an  alias
         of the form

             @: @

         (which  is  not  normally  legal).  Before sendmail
         will access the database, it checks to insure  that
         this entry exists[11].

      2.6.3.  List owners

              If an error occurs on sending to a certain ad-
         dress, say "x", sendmail will look for an alias  of
         the  form "owner-x" to receive the errors.  This is
         typically useful for a mailing list where the  sub-
         mitter  of the list has no control over the mainte-
         nance of the list itself; in  this  case  the  list
         maintainer would be the owner of the list.  For ex-
         ample:

             unix-wizards: eric@ucbarpa, wnj@monet, nosuchuser,
                  sam@matisse
             owner-unix-wizards: unix-wizards-request
             unix-wizards-request: eric@ucbarpa

         would  cause  "eric@ucbarpa"  to get the error that
         will occur when someone sends to  unix-wizards  due
         to the inclusion of "nosuchuser" on the list.

              List owners also cause the envelope sender ad-
         dress  to  be  modified.  The contents of the owner
         alias are used if they point to a single user, oth-
         erwise the name of the alias itself is  used.   For
         this  reason, and to obey Internet conventions, the
         "owner-" address normally points at the  "-request"
         address;  this  causes  messages to go out with the
         typical Internet  convention  of  using  ``list-re-
         quest'' as the return address.

   2.7.  User Information Database

           This  option is deprecated, use virtusertable and
      genericstable instead as explained in  cf/README.   If
      you  have a version of sendmail with the user informa-
      tion database compiled in, and you have specified  one
____________________
   [11]The AliasWait option is required in the configuration
for  this  action  to occur.  This should normally be speci-
fied.












SMM:08-32          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      or  more  databases  using the U option, the databases
      will be searched for a user:maildrop entry.  If found,
      the mail will be sent to the specified address.

   2.8.  Per-User Forwarding (.forward Files)

           As an alternative to the alias database, any user
      may put a file with the name ".forward" in his or  her
      home  directory.   If this file exists, sendmail redi-
      rects mail for that user  to  the  list  of  addresses
      listed  in  the  .forward file.  Note that aliases are
      fully expanded before forward  files  are  referenced.
      For example, if the home directory for user "mckusick"
      has a .forward file with contents:

          mckusick@ernie
          kirk@calder

      then  any  mail  arriving for "mckusick" will be redi-
      rected to the specified accounts.

           Actually, the configuration file  defines  a  se-
      quence of filenames to check.  By default, this is the
      user's  .forward  file,  but can be defined to be more
      generally using the ForwardPath option.  If you change
      this, you will have to inform your user  base  of  the
      change;  .forward is pretty well incorporated into the
      collective subconscious.

   2.9.  Special Header Lines

           Several header lines have special interpretations
      defined by the configuration file.  Others have inter-
      pretations built into sendmail that cannot be  changed
      without  changing  the  code.  These built-ins are de-
      scribed here.

      2.9.1.  Errors-To:

              If errors occur  anywhere  during  processing,
         this  header will cause error messages to go to the
         listed addresses.  This  is  intended  for  mailing
         lists.

              The  Errors-To:  header was created in the bad
         old days when UUCP didn't understand  the  distinc-
         tion  between  an envelope and a header; this was a
         hack to provide what should now be  passed  as  the
         envelope sender address.  It should go away.  It is
         only used if the UseErrorsTo option is set.

              The Errors-To: header is officially deprecated
         and will go away in a future release.










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-33


      2.9.2.  Apparently-To:

              RFC  822 requires at least one recipient field
         (To:, Cc:, or Bcc: line) in every  message.   If  a
         message  comes  in with no recipients listed in the
         message then sendmail will adjust the header  based
         on the "NoRecipientAction" option.  One of the pos-
         sible  actions is to add an "Apparently-To:" header
         line for any recipients it is aware of.

              The Apparently-To: header is non-standard  and
         is both deprecated and strongly discouraged.

      2.9.3.  Precedence

              The  Precedence: header can be used as a crude
         control of message priority.  It  tweaks  the  sort
         order  in the queue and can be configured to change
         the message timeout values.  The  precedence  of  a
         message also controls how delivery status notifica-
         tions (DSNs) are processed for that message.

   2.10.  IDENT Protocol Support

           Sendmail  supports  the IDENT protocol as defined
      in RFC 1413.  Note that the RFC states a client should
      wait at least 30 seconds for a response.  The  default
      Timeout.ident  is 5 seconds as many sites have adopted
      the practice of dropping IDENT queries.  This has lead
      to delays processing  mail.   Although  this  enhances
      identification  of  the  author of an email message by
      doing a ``call back'' to the originating system to in-
      clude the owner of a particular TCP connection in  the
      audit  trail  it  is in no sense perfect; a determined
      forger can easily spoof the IDENT protocol.  The  fol-
      lowing description is excerpted from RFC 1413:

           6.  Security Considerations

           The  information  returned by this protocol is at
           most as trustworthy as the host providing  it  OR
           the  organization  operating the host.  For exam-
           ple, a PC in an open lab has few if any  controls
           on it to prevent a user from having this protocol
           return  any identifier the user wants.  Likewise,
           if the host has been compromised the  information
           returned may be completely erroneous and mislead-
           ing.

           The Identification Protocol is not intended as an
           authorization  or  access  control  protocol.  At
           best, it provides some additional auditing infor-
           mation  with  respect  to  TCP  connections.   At










SMM:08-34          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


           worst,  it  can provide misleading, incorrect, or
           maliciously incorrect information.

           The use of the information returned by this  pro-
           tocol  for  other  than auditing is strongly dis-
           couraged.   Specifically,  using   Identification
           Protocol information to make access control deci-
           sions  -  either  as the primary method (i.e., no
           other checks) or as an adjunct to  other  methods
           may  result  in  a weakening of normal host secu-
           rity.

           An Identification server may  reveal  information
           about users, entities, objects or processes which
           might normally be considered private.  An Identi-
           fication server provides service which is a rough
           analog  of the CallerID services provided by some
           phone companies and many of the same privacy con-
           siderations and arguments that apply to the  Cal-
           lerID  service  apply  to Identification.  If you
           wouldn't run a "finger"  server  due  to  privacy
           considerations  you may not want to run this pro-
           tocol.

      In some cases your system may not work  properly  with
      IDENT  support  due to a bug in the TCP/IP implementa-
      tion.  The symptoms will be that for  some  hosts  the
      SMTP connection will be closed almost immediately.  If
      this  is  true or if you do not want to use IDENT, you
      should set the IDENT timeout to zero; this  will  dis-
      able the IDENT protocol.

3.  ARGUMENTS

        The  complete  list  of arguments to sendmail is de-
   scribed in detail in Appendix A.   Some  important  argu-
   ments are described here.

   3.1.  Queue Interval

           The  amount  of time between forking a process to
      run through the queue is defined by the -q  flag.   If
      you  run  with delivery mode set to i or b this can be
      relatively large, since it will only be relevant  when
      a  host  that was down comes back up.  If you run in q
      mode it should be relatively short, since  it  defines
      the  maximum  amount of time that a message may sit in
      the queue.  (See also the MinQueueAge option.)

           RFC 1123 section 5.3.1.1  says  that  this  value
      should  be at least 30 minutes (although that probably
      doesn't make sense if you use ``queue-only'' mode).











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-35


           Notice: the meaning of the interval time  depends
      on  whether  normal  queue runners or persistent queue
      runners are used.  For the former, it is the time  be-
      tween  subsequent starts of a queue run.  For the lat-
      ter, it is the time sendmail waits after a  persistent
      queue  runner  has finished its work to start the next
      one.  Hence for persistent queue runners this interval
      should be very low, typically no more  than  two  min-
      utes.

   3.2.  Daemon Mode

           If  you  allow  incoming mail over an IPC connec-
      tion, you should have a daemon running.   This  should
      be  set  by your /etc/rc file using the -bd flag.  The
      -bd flag and the -q flag may be combined in one call:

          /usr/sbin/sendmail -bd -q30m


           An alternative approach  is  to  invoke  sendmail
      from  inetd(8)  (use the -bs -Am flags to ask sendmail
      to speak SMTP on its standard input and output and  to
      run  as MTA).  This works and allows you to wrap send-
      mail in a TCP wrapper program, but may be a bit slower
      since the configuration file  has  to  be  re-read  on
      every  message  that  comes  in.   If you do this, you
      still need to have a sendmail  running  to  flush  the
      queue:

          /usr/sbin/sendmail -q30m


   3.3.  Forcing the Queue

           In  some  cases  you  may find that the queue has
      gotten clogged for some reason.  You can force a queue
      run using the -q flag (with no value).  It  is  enter-
      taining to use the -v flag (verbose) when this is done
      to watch what happens:

          /usr/sbin/sendmail -q -v


           You  can also limit the jobs to those with a par-
      ticular queue identifier, recipient,  sender,  quaran-
      tine  reason,  or  queue  group using one of the queue
      modifiers.  For example, "-qRberkeley"  restricts  the
      queue  run  to  jobs  that  have the string "berkeley"
      somewhere in one of the  recipient  addresses.   Simi-
      larly,   "-qSstring"  limits  the  run  to  particular
      senders, "-qIstring" limits  it  to  particular  queue
      identifiers,  and  "-qQstring" limits it to particular










SMM:08-36          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      quarantined reasons and only operated  on  quarantined
      queue items, and "-qGstring" limits it to a particular
      queue  group.   The named queue group will be run even
      if it is set to have 0 runners.  You may also place an
      !  before the I or R or S or Q to indicate  that  jobs
      are  limited to not including a particular queue iden-
      tifier, recipient or sender.  For example,  "-q!Rseat-
      tle" limits the queue run to jobs that do not have the
      string "seattle" somewhere in one of the recipient ad-
      dresses.   Should you need to terminate the queue jobs
      currently active then a SIGTERM to the parent  of  the
      process (or processes) will cleanly stop the jobs.

   3.4.  Debugging

           There  are  a  fairly large number of debug flags
      built into sendmail.  Each debug flag has  a  category
      and  a level.  Higher levels increase the level of de-
      bugging activity; in most cases, this means  to  print
      out  more  information.  The convention is that levels
      greater than nine are "absurd," i.e., they  print  out
      so much information that you wouldn't normally want to
      see them except for debugging that particular piece of
      code.

           You should never run a production sendmail server
      in debug mode.  Many of the debug flags will result in
      debug  output  being sent over the SMTP channel unless
      the option -D is used.  This will  confuse  many  mail
      programs.   However,  for  testing purposes, it can be
      useful when sending mail manually via  telnet  to  the
      port you are using while debugging.

           A  debug  category is either an integer, like 42,
      or a name, like ANSI.  You can specify a range of  nu-
      meric  debug  categories  using the syntax 17-42.  You
      can specify a set of named debug  categories  using  a
      glob  pattern like "sm_trace_*".  At present, only "*"
      and "?"  are supported in these glob patterns.

           Debug flags are set using the -d option; the syn-
      tax is:

          debug-flag:        -d debug-list
          debug-list:        debug-option [ , debug-option ]*
          debug-option:      debug-categories [ . debug-level ]
          debug-categories:  integer | integer - integer | category-pattern
          category-pattern:  [a-zA-Z_*?][a-zA-Z0-9_*?]*
          debug-level:       integer

      where spaces are for reading ease only.  For example,












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-37


          -d12               Set category 12 to level 1
          -d12.3             Set category 12 to level 3
          -d3-17             Set categories 3 through 17 to level 1
          -d3-17.4           Set categories 3 through 17 to level 4
          -dANSI             Set category ANSI to level 1
          -dsm_trace_*.3     Set all named categories matching sm_trace_* to level 3

      For a complete list of the available debug  flags  you
      will  have to look at the code and the TRACEFLAGS file
      in the sendmail distribution (they are too dynamic  to
      keep  this  document up to date).  For a list of named
      debug categories in the sendmail binary, use

          ident /usr/sbin/sendmail | grep Debug


   3.5.  Changing the Values of Options

           Options can be overridden using the -o or -O com-
      mand line flags.  For example,

          /usr/sbin/sendmail -oT2m

      sets the T (timeout) option to two  minutes  for  this
      run  only;  the  equivalent line using the long option
      name is

          /usr/sbin/sendmail -OTimeout.queuereturn=2m


           Some options have security  implications.   Send-
      mail  allows  you  to  set these, but relinquishes its
      set-user-ID   or   set-group-ID   permissions   there-
      after[12].

   3.6.  Trying a Different Configuration File

           An alternative configuration file can  be  speci-
      fied using the -C flag; for example,

          /usr/sbin/sendmail -Ctest.cf -oQ/tmp/mqueue

      uses the configuration file test.cf instead of the de-
      fault  /etc/mail/sendmail.cf.   If  the -C flag has no
      value it defaults to sendmail.cf in the current direc-
      tory.
____________________
   [12]That  is,  it sets its effective uid to the real uid;
thus, if you are executing as root, as from  root's  crontab
file  or  during  system  startup  the root permissions will
still be honored.












SMM:08-38          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


           Sendmail gives up  set-user-ID  root  permissions
      (if  it  has been installed set-user-ID root) when you
      use this flag, so it  is  common  to  use  a  publicly
      writable  directory (such as /tmp) as the queue direc-
      tory (QueueDirectory or Q option) while testing.

   3.7.  Logging Traffic

           Many SMTP implementations do not fully  implement
      the  protocol.   For  example,  some personal computer
      based SMTPs do not understand  continuation  lines  in
      reply codes.  These can be very hard to trace.  If you
      suspect  such  a  problem, you can set traffic logging
      using the -X flag.  For example,

          /usr/sbin/sendmail -X /tmp/traffic -bd

      will log all traffic in the file /tmp/traffic.

           This logs a lot of data very quickly  and  should
      NEVER  be used during normal operations.  After start-
      ing up such a daemon, force the errant  implementation
      to  send  a message to your host.  All message traffic
      in and out of sendmail, including  the  incoming  SMTP
      traffic, will be logged in this file.

   3.8.  Testing Configuration Files

           When  you build a configuration table, you can do
      a certain amount of testing using the "test  mode"  of
      sendmail.  For example, you could invoke sendmail as:

          sendmail -bt -Ctest.cf

      which  would read the configuration file "test.cf" and
      enter test mode.  In this mode, you enter lines of the
      form:

          rwset address

      where rwset is the rewriting set you want to  use  and
      address  is an address to apply the set to.  Test mode
      shows you the steps it takes as it  proceeds,  finally
      showing  you the address it ends up with.  You may use
      a comma separated list of rwsets for sequential appli-
      cation of rules to an input.  For example:

          3,1,21,4 monet:bollard

      first applies ruleset three to the  input  "monet:bol-
      lard."   Ruleset  one is then applied to the output of
      ruleset three, followed similarly by rulesets  twenty-
      one and four.










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-39


           If  you  need  more  detail, you can also use the
      "-d21" flag to turn on more debugging.  For example,

          sendmail -bt -d21.99

      turns on an incredible amount of information; a single
      word address is probably going to  print  out  several
      pages worth of information.

           You  should  be  warned that internally, sendmail
      applies ruleset 3 to all addresses.  In test mode  you
      will  have  to  do  that manually.  For example, older
      versions allowed you to use

          0 bruce@broadcast.sony.com

      This version requires that you use:

          3,0 bruce@broadcast.sony.com


           As of version 8.7, some other syntaxes are avail-
      able in test mode:

      .Dxvalue  defines macro x to have the indicated value.
                This is useful when debugging rules that use
                the $&x syntax.

      .Ccvalue  adds the indicated value to class c.

      =Sruleset dumps the contents of the indicated ruleset.

      -ddebug-spec
                is equivalent to the command-line flag.

      Version 8.9 introduced more features:

      ?         shows a help message.

      =M        display the known mailers.

      $m        print the value of macro m.

      $=c       print the contents of class c.

      /mx host  returns the MX records for `host'.

      /parse address
                parse address, returning the value of crack-
                addr, and the parsed address.

      /try mailer addr
                rewrite address into the form it  will  have










SMM:08-40          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                when presented to the indicated mailer.

      /tryflags flags
                set flags used by parsing.  The flags can be
                `H'  for Header or `E' for Envelope, and `S'
                for Sender or `R' for Recipient.  These  can
                be  combined, `HR' sets flags for header re-
                cipients.

      /canon hostname
                try to canonify hostname.

      /map mapname key
                look up `key' in the indicated `mapname'.

      /quit     quit address test mode.

   3.9.  Persistent Host Status Information

           When HostStatusDirectory is enabled,  information
      about  the  status  of hosts is maintained on disk and
      can thus be shared between different instantiations of
      sendmail.  The status of the last connection with each
      remote host may be viewed with the command:

          sendmail -bh

      This information may be flushed with the command:

          sendmail -bH

      Flushing  the  information   prevents   new   sendmail
      processes from loading it, but does not prevent exist-
      ing  processes  from using the status information that
      they already have.

4.  TUNING

        There are a number of configuration  parameters  you
   may want to change, depending on the requirements of your
   site.   Most of these are set using an option in the con-
   figuration  file.   For  example,  the  line   "O   Time-
   out.queuereturn=5d"  sets option "Timeout.queuereturn" to
   the value "5d" (five days).

        Most of these options have appropriate defaults  for
   most  sites.   However, sites having very high mail loads
   may find they need to tune them as appropriate for  their
   mail  load.   In  particular,  sites experiencing a large
   number of small messages, many of which are delivered  to
   many  recipients,  may  find that they need to adjust the
   parameters dealing with queue priorities.











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-41


        All versions of sendmail prior  to  8.7  had  single
   character  option  names.   As  of 8.7, options have long
   (multi-character names).  Although old  short  names  are
   still accepted, most new options do not have short equiv-
   alents.

        This section only describes the options you are most
   likely to want to tweak; read section 5 for more details.

   4.1.  Timeouts

           All time intervals are set using a scaled syntax.
      For  example,  "10m"  represents  ten minutes, whereas
      "2h30m" represents two and a half hours.  The full set
      of scales is:

          s   seconds
          m   minutes
          h   hours
          d   days
          w   weeks


      4.1.1.  Queue interval

              The argument to the -q flag specifies how  of-
         ten a sub-daemon will run the queue.  This is typi-
         cally  set to between fifteen minutes and one hour.
         If not set, or set to zero, the queue will  not  be
         run automatically.  RFC 1123 section 5.3.1.1 recom-
         mends that this be at least 30 minutes.  Should you
         need  to  terminate the queue jobs currently active
         then a SIGTERM to the parent  of  the  process  (or
         processes) will cleanly stop the jobs.

      4.1.2.  Read timeouts

              Timeouts all have option names "Timeout.subop-
         tion".  Most of these control SMTP operations.  The
         recognized  suboptions,  their  default values, and
         the minimum values  allowed  by  RFC  2821  section
         4.5.3.2 (or RFC 1123 section 5.3.2) are:

         connect   The  time  to wait for an SMTP connection
                   to open (the connect(2) system call)  [0,
                   unspecified].   If  zero, uses the kernel
                   default.  In no case can this option  ex-
                   tend  the  timeout longer than the kernel
                   provides, but it can shorten it.  This is
                   to get around kernels that provide an ab-
                   surdly long connection timeout  (90  min-
                   utes in one case).











SMM:08-42          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


         iconnect  The  same  as  connect, except it applies
                   only to the initial attempt to connect to
                   a host for a given message  [0,  unspeci-
                   fied].   The  concept is that this should
                   be very short (a few seconds); hosts that
                   are well connected  and  responsive  will
                   thus be serviced immediately.  Hosts that
                   are  slow will not hold up other deliver-
                   ies in the initial delivery attempt.

         aconnect  [0,  unspecified]  The  overall   timeout
                   waiting  for  all connection for a single
                   delivery attempt to succeed.   If  0,  no
                   overall  limit  is  applied.  This can be
                   used to restrict the total amount of time
                   trying to connect to a long list of  host
                   that  could  accept an e-mail for the re-
                   cipient.  This timeout does not apply  to
                   FallbackMXhost,  i.e., if the time is ex-
                   hausted,  the  FallbackMXhost  is   tried
                   next.

         initial   The  wait  for  the  initial 220 greeting
                   message [5m, 5m].

         helo      The wait for a reply from a HELO or  EHLO
                   command  [5m, unspecified].  This may re-
                   quire a host name lookup, so five minutes
                   is probably a reasonable minimum.

         mail*     The wait for a reply from a MAIL  command
                   [10m, 5m].

         rcpt*     The  wait for a reply from a RCPT command
                   [1h, 5m].  This should be long because it
                   could be pointing at a list that takes  a
                   long time to expand (see below).

         datainit* The  wait for a reply from a DATA command
                   [5m, 2m].

         datablock*#
                   The wait for reading a data  block  (that
                   is,  the body of the message).  [1h, 3m].
                   This should be long because it  also  ap-
                   plies  to  programs piping input to send-
                   mail which have no guarantee  of  prompt-
                   ness.

         datafinal*
                   The  wait for a reply from the dot termi-
                   nating a message.  [1h, 10m].  If this is
                   shorter than the time actually needed for










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-43


                   the receiver to deliver the message,  du-
                   plicates will be generated.  This is dis-
                   cussed in RFC 1047.

         rset      The  wait for a reply from a RSET command
                   [5m, unspecified].

         quit      The wait for a reply from a QUIT  command
                   [2m, unspecified].

         misc      The  wait  for a reply from miscellaneous
                   (but short) commands such as NOOP (no-op-
                   eration) and VERB (go into verbose mode).
                   [2m, unspecified].

         command*# In server SMTP, the time to wait for  an-
                   other command.  [1h, 5m].

         ident#    The  timeout  waiting  for  a reply to an
                   IDENT query [5s[13], unspecified].

         lhlo      The wait for a reply to an LMTP LHLO com-
                   mand [2m, unspecified].

         auth      The  timeout  for a reply in an SMTP AUTH
                   dialogue [10m, unspecified].

         starttls  The timeout for a reply to an SMTP START-
                   TLS command and the  TLS  handshake  [1h,
                   unspecified].

         fileopen# The timeout for opening .forward and :in-
                   clude: files [60s, none].

         control#  The timeout for a complete control socket
                   transaction to complete [2m, none].

         hoststatus#
                   How  long status information about a host
                   (e.g., host down) will be  cached  before
                   it  is  considered  stale  [30m, unspeci-
                   fied].

         resolver.retrans#
                   The resolver's retransmission time inter-
                   val (in  seconds)  [varies].   Sets  both
                   Timeout.resolver.retrans.first  and Time-
                   out.resolver.retrans.normal.
____________________
   [13]On some systems the default is zero to turn the  pro-
tocol off entirely.












SMM:08-44          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


         resolver.retrans.first#
                   The resolver's retransmission time inter-
                   val (in seconds) for the first attempt to
                   deliver a message [varies].

         resolver.retrans.normal#
                   The resolver's retransmission time inter-
                   val (in seconds) for all resolver lookups
                   except   the   first   delivery   attempt
                   [varies].

         resolver.retry#
                   The  number  of times to retransmit a re-
                   solver  query.   Sets  both   Timeout.re-
                   solver.retry.first     and    Timeout.re-
                   solver.retry.normal [varies].

         resolver.retry.first#
                   The number of times to retransmit  a  re-
                   solver query for the first attempt to de-
                   liver a message [varies].

         resolver.retry.normal#
                   The  number  of times to retransmit a re-
                   solver query for all resolver lookups
                    except  the   first   delivery   attempt
                   [varies].

         For  compatibility with old configuration files, if
         no suboption is specified, all the timeouts  marked
         with  an  asterick  (*)  are  set  to the indicated
         value.  All but those marked with a pound sign  (#)
         apply to client SMTP.

              For example, the lines:

             O Timeout.command=25m
             O Timeout.datablock=3h

         sets  the server SMTP command timeout to 25 minutes
         and the input data block timeout to three hours.

      4.1.3.  Message timeouts

              After sitting in the queue for a few days,  an
         undeliverable  message  will  time out.  This is to
         insure that at least the sender is aware of the in-
         ability to send a message.  The  timeout  is  typi-
         cally set to five days.  It is sometimes considered
         convenient  to  also  send a warning message if the
         message is in the queue longer  than  a  few  hours
         (assuming  you  normally have good connectivity; if
         your messages normally took several hours  to  send










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-45


         you wouldn't want to do this because it wouldn't be
         an  unusual  event).   These timeouts are set using
         the Timeout.queuereturn and  Timeout.queuewarn  op-
         tions  in  the  configuration file (previously both
         were set using the T option).

              If the message is submitted using  the  NOTIFY
         SMTP  extension, warning messages will only be sent
         if NOTIFY=DELAY is specified.  The queuereturn  and
         queuewarn  timeouts can be further qualified with a
         tag based on the Precedence: field in the  message;
         they must be one of "urgent" (indicating a positive
         non-zero  precedence),  "normal" (indicating a zero
         precedence), or "non-urgent"  (indicating  negative
         precedences).  For example, setting "Timeout.queue-
         warn.urgent=1h" sets the warning timeout for urgent
         messages  only  to  one  hour.   The  default if no
         precedence is indicated is to set the  timeout  for
         all  precedences.  If the message has a normal (de-
         fault) precedence and it is a delivery status noti-
         fication (DSN), Timeout.queuereturn.dsn  and  Time-
         out.queuewarn.dsn  can  be used to give an alterna-
         tive warn and return  time  for  DSNs.   The  value
         "now" can be used for -O Timeout.queuereturn to re-
         turn  entries immediately during a queue run, e.g.,
         to bounce messages independent of their time in the
         queue.

              Since these options are global, and since  you
         cannot  know a priori how long another host outside
         your domain will be down, a  five  day  timeout  is
         recommended.   This  allows  a recipient to fix the
         problem even if it occurs at  the  beginning  of  a
         long  weekend.   RFC 1123 section 5.3.1.1 says that
         this parameter should be ``at least 4-5 days''.

              The Timeout.queuewarn value can be piggybacked
         on the T option by indicating a time after which  a
         warning  message  should  be sent; the two timeouts
         are separated by a slash.  For example, the line

             OT5d/4h

         causes email to fail after five days, but a warning
         message will be sent after four hours.  This should
         be large enough that the  message  will  have  been
         tried several times.

   4.2.  Forking During Queue Runs

           By  setting  the ForkEachJob (Y) option, sendmail
      will fork before each individual message while running
      the queue.  This option was used with earlier releases










SMM:08-46          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      to prevent sendmail from consuming  large  amounts  of
      memory.   It  should no longer be necessary with send-
      mail 8.12.  If the  ForkEachJob  option  is  not  set,
      sendmail will keep track of hosts that are down during
      a  queue  run,  which can improve performance dramati-
      cally.

           If the ForkEachJob option is set, sendmail cannot
      use connection caching.

   4.3.  Queue Priorities

           Every message is assigned a priority when  it  is
      first instantiated, consisting of the message size (in
      bytes)  offset  by  the message class (which is deter-
      mined from the Precedence:  header)  times  the  "work
      class  factor"  and the number of recipients times the
      "work recipient factor."  The priority is used to  or-
      der  the  queue.  Higher numbers for the priority mean
      that the message will be processed later when  running
      the queue.

           The  message  size is included so that large mes-
      sages are penalized relative to small  messages.   The
      message  class  allows  users  to send "high priority"
      messages by including a "Precedence:" field  in  their
      message; the value of this field is looked up in the P
      lines  of the configuration file.  Since the number of
      recipients  affects  the  amount  of  load  a  message
      presents to the system, this is also included into the
      priority.

           The recipient and class factors can be set in the
      configuration  file  using the RecipientFactor (y) and
      ClassFactor (z) options respectively.  They default to
      30000 (for the recipient factor)  and  1800  (for  the
      class factor).  The initial priority is:

     pri=msgsize-(classxClassFactor)+(nrcptxRecipientFactor)

      (Remember,  higher  values for this parameter actually
      mean that the job will be treated  with  lower  prior-
      ity.)

           The  priority  of a job can also be adjusted each
      time it is processed (that is, each time an attempt is
      made to deliver it) using the "work time factor,"  set
      by  the  RetryFactor (Z) option.  This is added to the
      priority, so it normally decreases the  precedence  of
      the  job,  on  the  grounds that jobs that have failed
      many times will tend to fail again in the future.  The
      RetryFactor option defaults to 90000.











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-47


   4.4.  Load Limiting

           Sendmail can be asked to queue (but not  deliver)
      mail  if  the  system load average gets too high using
      the QueueLA (x) option.  When the load average exceeds
      the value of the QueueLA option, the delivery mode  is
      set  to  q  (queue only) if the QueueFactor (q) option
      divided by the difference in the current load  average
      and  the QueueLA option plus one is less than the pri-
      ority of the message -- that is, the message is queued
      iff:

                        pri>LQueueFactor_

      The QueueFactor option defaults  to  600000,  so  each
      point  of load average is worth 600000 priority points
      (as described above).

           For drastic cases, the RefuseLA  (X)  option  de-
      fines  a load average at which sendmail will refuse to
      accept network connections.  Locally  generated  mail,
      i.e.,  mail which is not submitted via SMTP (including
      incoming UUCP mail), is still accepted.   Notice  that
      the  MSP  submits  mail to the MTA via SMTP, and hence
      mail will be queued in the  client  queue  in  such  a
      case.   Therefore  it  is  necessary to run the client
      mail queue periodically.

   4.5.  Resource Limits

           Sendmail has several parameters  to  control  re-
      source usage.  Besides those mentioned in the previous
      section, there are at least MaxDaemonChildren, Connec-
      tionRateThrottle,    MaxQueueChildren,   and   MaxRun-
      nersPerQueue.  The latter  two  limit  the  number  of
      sendmail  processes  that operate on the queue.  These
      are discussed in the section  ``Queue  Group  Declara-
      tion''.   The former two can be used to limit the num-
      ber of incoming connections.  Their appropriate values
      depend on the host operating system and the  hardware,
      e.g.,  amount  of memory.  In many situations it might
      be useful to set limits to prevent to  have  too  many
      sendmail  processes,  however,  these  limits  can  be
      abused to mount a denial of service attack.  For exam-
      ple, if MaxDaemonChildren=10 then an attacker needs to
      open only 10 SMTP sessions to the server,  leave  them
      idle  for  most  of  the time, and no more connections
      will be accepted.  If this  option  is  set  then  the
      timeouts used in a SMTP session should be lowered from
      their default values to their minimum values as speci-
      fied in RFC 2821 and listed in section 4.1.2.












SMM:08-48          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


   4.6.  Measures against Denial of Service Attacks

           Sendmail  has some built-in measures against sim-
      ple denial of service (DoS) attacks.  The SMTP  server
      by default slows down if too many bad commands are is-
      sued or if some commands are repeated too often within
      a  session.   Details  can be found in the source file
      sendmail/srvrsmtp.c by looking for the  macro  defini-
      tions  of MAXBADCOMMANDS, MAXNOOPCOMMANDS, MAXHELOCOM-
      MANDS, MAXVRFYCOMMANDS, and  MAXETRNCOMMANDS.   If  an
      SMTP command is issued more often than the correspond-
      ing MAXcmdCOMMANDS value, then the response is delayed
      exponentially,  starting with a sleep time of one sec-
      ond, up to a maximum of four minutes  (as  defined  by
      MAXTIMEOUT).   If  the option MaxDaemonChildren is set
      to a value greater than zero, then this could  make  a
      DoS attack even worse since it keeps a connection open
      longer than necessary.  Therefore a connection is ter-
      minated  with  a  421 SMTP reply code if the number of
      commands exceeds the limit by  a  factor  of  two  and
      MAXBADCOMMANDS  is  set  to  a value greater than zero
      (the default is 25).

   4.7.  Delivery Mode

           There are a number of delivery modes  that  send-
      mail  can operate in, set by the DeliveryMode (d) con-
      figuration option.  These modes  specify  how  quickly
      mail will be delivered.  Legal modes are:

          i   deliver interactively (synchronously)
          b   deliver in background (asynchronously)
          q   queue only (don't deliver)
          d   defer delivery attempts (don't deliver)

      There  are  tradeoffs.   Mode "i" gives the sender the
      quickest feedback, but may slow down some mailers  and
      is  hardly ever necessary.  Mode "b" delivers promptly
      but can cause large numbers of processes if you have a
      mailer that takes a long time to  deliver  a  message.
      Mode "q" minimizes the load on your machine, but means
      that  delivery  may be delayed for up to the queue in-
      terval.  Mode "d" is identical to mode "q" except that
      it also prevents lookups in maps including the -D flag
      from working during the initial queue phase; it is in-
      tended for ``dial on demand'' sites where DNS  lookups
      might  cost  real  money.   Some simple error messages
      (e.g., host unknown during the SMTP protocol) will  be
      delayed  using  this  mode.  Mode "b" is the usual de-
      fault.

           If you run in mode "q" (queue only), "d" (defer),
      or "b"  (deliver  in  background)  sendmail  will  not










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-49


      expand  aliases and follow .forward files upon initial
      receipt of the mail.  This speeds up the  response  to
      RCPT  commands.   Mode  "i"  should not be used by the
      SMTP server.

   4.8.  Log Level

           The level of logging can  be  set  for  sendmail.
      The default using a standard configuration is level 9.
      The  levels  are  approximately  as  follows (some log
      types are using different level depending  on  various
      factors):

      0    Minimal logging.

      1    Serious  system  failures  and potential security
           problems.

      2    Lost communications (network problems) and proto-
           col failures.

      3    Other  serious  failures,  malformed   addresses,
           transient   forward/include   errors,  connection
           timeouts.

      4    Minor failures, out of date alias databases, con-
           nection rejections via check_ rulesets.

      5    Message collection statistics.

      6    Creation of error messages, VRFY  and  EXPN  com-
           mands.

      7    Delivery failures (host or user unknown, etc.).

      8    Successful  deliveries  and  alias  database  re-
           builds.

      9    Messages being deferred  (due  to  a  host  being
           down, etc.).

      10   Database  expansion  (alias,  forward, and userdb
           lookups) and authentication information.

      11   NIS errors and end of job processing.

      12   Logs all SMTP connections.

      13   Log bad user shells, files with improper  permis-
           sions, and other questionable situations.

      14   Logs refused connections.











SMM:08-50          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      15   Log all incoming SMTP commands.

      20   Logs  attempts  to run locked queue files.  These
           are not errors, but can be useful to note if your
           queue appears to be clogged.

      30   Lost  locks  (only  if  using  lockf  instead  of
           flock).

      Additionally,  values  above  64  are reserved for ex-
      tremely verbose  debugging  output.   No  normal  site
      would ever set these.

   4.9.  File Modes

           The modes used for files depend on what function-
      ality  you want and the level of security you require.
      In many cases sendmail does careful  checking  of  the
      modes  of  files  and  directories to avoid accidental
      compromise; if you want to make it  possible  to  have
      group-writable  support  files you may need to use the
      DontBlameSendmail option to turn  off  some  of  these
      checks.

      4.9.1.  To suid or not to suid?

              Sendmail is no longer installed set-user-ID to
         root.   sendmail/SECURITY explains how to configure
         and install sendmail without  set-user-ID  to  root
         but set-group-ID which is the default configuration
         starting with 8.12.

              The  daemon usually runs as root, unless other
         measures are taken.  At the point where sendmail is
         about to exec(2) a mailer, it checks to see if  the
         userid  is zero (root); if so, it resets the userid
         and groupid to a default (set by the U=  equate  in
         the  mailer  line; if that is not set, the Default-
         User option is used).  This can  be  overridden  by
         setting  the  S flag to the mailer for mailers that
         are trusted and must be called as  root.   However,
         this  will  cause  mail  processing to be accounted
         (using sa(8)) to root rather than to the user send-
         ing the mail.

              A middle ground is to set  the  RunAsUser  op-
         tion.  This causes sendmail to become the indicated
         user  as  soon  as it has done the startup that re-
         quires root privileges (primarily, opening the SMTP
         socket).  If you use RunAsUser, the queue directory
         (normally /var/spool/mqueue)  should  be  owned  by
         that  user,  and all files and databases (including
         user .forward files, alias files, :include:  files,










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-51


         and  external  databases)  must be readable by that
         user.  Also, since sendmail will  not  be  able  to
         change  its uid, delivery to programs or files will
         be marked as unsafe, e.g., undeliverable, in  .for-
         ward, aliases, and :include: files.  Administrators
         can  override this by setting the DontBlameSendmail
         option to the setting  NonRootSafeAddr.   RunAsUser
         is probably best suited for firewall configurations
         that don't have regular user logins.  If the option
         is  used on a system which performs local delivery,
         then the local delivery agent must have the  proper
         permissions  (i.e., usually set-user-ID root) since
         it will be invoked by the RunAsUser, not by root.

      4.9.2.  Turning off security checks

              Sendmail is very particular about the modes of
         files that it reads or writes.  For example, by de-
         fault it will refuse to read most  files  that  are
         group  writable on the grounds that they might have
         been tampered with by someone other than the owner;
         it will even refuse to read files in group writable
         directories.  Also, sendmail will refuse to  create
         a new aliases database in an unsafe directory.  You
         can  get around this by manually creating the data-
         base file as a trusted user ahead of time and  then
         rebuilding the aliases database with newaliases.

              If  you are quite sure that your configuration
         is safe and you want sendmail to avoid these  secu-
         rity  checks, you can turn off certain checks using
         the DontBlameSendmail option.   This  option  takes
         one  or more names that disable checks.  In the de-
         scriptions that follow, "unsafe directory" means  a
         directory that is writable by anyone other than the
         owner.  The values are:

         Safe No special handling.

         AssumeSafeChown
              Assume  that  the  chown  system  call  is re-
              stricted to root.  Since some versions of UNIX
              permit regular users to give away their  files
              to  other  users on some filesystems, sendmail
              often cannot assume that a given file was cre-
              ated by the owner, particularly when it is  in
              a  writable  directory.  You can set this flag
              if you know that file giveaway  is  restricted
              on your system.

         CertOwner
              Accept  certificate  public  and  private  key
              files which are not  owned  by  RunAsUser  for










SMM:08-52          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


              STARTTLS.

         ClassFileInUnsafeDirPath
              When  reading class files (using the F line in
              the configuration file), allow files that  are
              in unsafe directories.

         DontWarnForwardFileInUnsafeDirPath
              Prevent logging of unsafe directory path warn-
              ings for non-existent forward files.

         ErrorHeaderInUnsafeDirPath
              Allow the file named in the ErrorHeader option
              to be in an unsafe directory.

         FileDeliveryToHardLink
              Allow delivery to files that are hard links.

         FileDeliveryToSymLink
              Allow  delivery  to  files  that  are symbolic
              links.

         ForwardFileInGroupWritableDirPath
              Allow .forward files in group writable  direc-
              tories.

         ForwardFileInUnsafeDirPath
              Allow .forward files in unsafe directories.

         ForwardFileInUnsafeDirPathSafe
              Allow a .forward file that is in an unsafe di-
              rectory  to  include references to program and
              files.

         GroupReadableKeyFile
              Accept a group-readable key file for STARTTLS.

         GroupReadableSASLDBFile
              Accept a group-readable  Cyrus  SASL  password
              file.

         GroupReadableDefaultAuthInfoFile
              Accept  a  group-readable DefaultAuthInfo file
              for SASL.

         GroupWritableAliasFile
              Allow group-writable alias files.

         GroupWritableDirPathSafe
              Change the definition of "unsafe directory" to
              consider  group-writable  directories  to   be
              safe.   World-writable  directories are always
              unsafe.










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-53


         GroupWritableForwardFile
              Allow group writable .forward files.

         GroupWritableForwardFileSafe
              Accept group-writable .forward files  as  safe
              for program and file delivery.

         GroupWritableIncludeFile
              Allow group writable :include: files.

         GroupWritableIncludeFileSafe
              Accept  group-writable :include: files as safe
              for program and file delivery.

         GroupWritableSASLDBFile
              Accept a group-writable  Cyrus  SASL  password
              file.

         HelpFileInUnsafeDirPath
              Allow the file named in the HelpFile option to
              be in an unsafe directory.

         IncludeFileInGroupWritableDirPath
              Allow :include: files in group writable direc-
              tories.

         IncludeFileInUnsafeDirPath
              Allow :include: files in unsafe directories.

         IncludeFileInUnsafeDirPathSafe
              Allow  a  :include:  file that is in an unsafe
              directory to include references to program and
              files.

         InsufficientEntropy
              Try to use  STARTTLS  even  if  the  PRNG  for
              OpenSSL is not properly seeded despite the se-
              curity problems.

         LinkedAliasFileInWritableDir
              Allow  an  alias  file  that  is  a  link in a
              writable directory.

         LinkedClassFileInWritableDir
              Allow class files that are links  in  writable
              directories.

         LinkedForwardFileInWritableDir
              Allow   .forward   files  that  are  links  in
              writable directories.

         LinkedIncludeFileInWritableDir
              Allow  :include:  files  that  are  links   in










SMM:08-54          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


              writable directories.

         LinkedMapInWritableDir
              Allow map files that are links in writable di-
              rectories.    This   includes  alias  database
              files.

         LinkedServiceSwitchFileInWritableDir
              Allow the service switch file  to  be  a  link
              even if the directory is writable.

         MapInUnsafeDirPath
              Allow  maps (e.g., hash, btree, and dbm files)
              in unsafe directories.   This  includes  alias
              database files.

         NonRootSafeAddr
              Do not mark file and program deliveries as un-
              safe  if  sendmail  is  not  running with root
              privileges.

         RunProgramInUnsafeDirPath
              Run programs that are in writable  directories
              without logging a warning.

         RunWritableProgram
              Run programs that are group- or world-writable
              without logging a warning.

         TrustStickyBit
              Allow  group  or world writable directories if
              the sticky bit is set on  the  directory.   Do
              not set this on systems which do not honor the
              sticky bit on directories.

         WorldWritableAliasFile
              Accept world-writable alias files.

         WorldWritableForwardfile
              Allow world writable .forward files.

         WorldWritableIncludefile
              Allow world writable :include: files.

         WriteMapToHardLink
              Allow writes to maps that are hard links.

         WriteMapToSymLink
              Allow writes to maps that are symbolic links.

         WriteStatsToHardLink
              Allow the status file to be a hard link.











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-55


         WriteStatsToSymLink
              Allow the status file to be a symbolic link.

   4.10.  Connection Caching

           When  processing  the queue, sendmail will try to
      keep the last  few  open  connections  open  to  avoid
      startup  and shutdown costs.  This only applies to IPC
      and LPC connections.

           When trying to open a  connection  the  cache  is
      first searched.  If an open connection is found, it is
      probed  to see if it is still active by sending a RSET
      command.  It is not an error if this  fails;  instead,
      the connection is closed and reopened.

           Two parameters control the connection cache.  The
      ConnectionCacheSize  (k)  option defines the number of
      simultaneous open connections that will be  permitted.
      If  it  is  set to zero, connections will be closed as
      quickly as possible.  The default is one.  This should
      be set as appropriate for your system  size;  it  will
      limit  the  amount  of  system resources that sendmail
      will use during queue runs.   Never  set  this  higher
      than 4.

           The  ConnectionCacheTimeout  (K) option specifies
      the maximum time that any cached  connection  will  be
      permitted  to  idle.   When the idle time exceeds this
      value the connection is closed.  This number should be
      small (under ten minutes) to prevent you from grabbing
      too many resources from other hosts.  The  default  is
      five minutes.

   4.11.  Name Server Access

           Control  of  host  address  lookups is set by the
      hosts service entry in your service switch  file.   If
      you  are  on a system that has built-in service switch
      support (e.g., Ultrix, Solaris,  or  DEC  OSF/1)  then
      your  system  is probably configured properly already.
      Otherwise,   sendmail   will    consult    the    file
      /etc/mail/service.switch,  which  should  be  created.
      Sendmail only uses two entries: hosts and aliases, al-
      though system routines may use other services (notably
      the passwd service for user  name  lookups  by  getpw-
      name).

           However, some systems (such as SunOS 4.X) will do
      DNS  lookups  regardless of the setting of the service
      switch entry.  In particular, the system routine geth-
      ostbyname(3) is used to look up host names,  and  many
      vendor  versions try some combination of DNS, NIS, and










SMM:08-56          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      file lookup in /etc/hosts without consulting a service
      switch.  Sendmail makes no attempt to work around this
      problem, and the DNS lookup will be done  anyway.   If
      you  do  not have a nameserver configured at all, such
      as at a UUCP-only site, sendmail will get  a  "connec-
      tion  refused" message when it tries to connect to the
      name server.  If the hosts switch entry has  the  ser-
      vice "dns" listed somewhere in the list, sendmail will
      interpret  this  to  mean a temporary failure and will
      queue the mail for later processing; otherwise, it ig-
      nores the name server data.

           The same technique is used to decide  whether  to
      do  MX lookups.  If you want MX support, you must have
      "dns" listed as a service in the hosts switch entry.

           The ResolverOptions  (I)  option  allows  you  to
      tweak  name  server options.  The command line takes a
      series of flags as documented in resolver(3) (with the
      leading "RES_" deleted).  Each can be preceded  by  an
      optional `+' or `-'.  For example, the line

          O ResolverOptions=+AAONLY -DNSRCH

      turns  on  the  AAONLY  (accept  authoritative answers
      only) and turns off  the  DNSRCH  (search  the  domain
      path)   options.    Most  resolver  libraries  default
      DNSRCH, DEFNAMES, and RECURSE flags on and all  others
      off.   If  NETINET6 is enabled, most libraries default
      to USE_INET6 as well.  You can also include  "HasWild-
      cardMX"  to specify that there is a wildcard MX record
      matching your domain; this turns off MX matching  when
      canonifying  names,  which  can  lead to inappropriate
      canonifications.   Use   "WorkAroundBrokenAAAA"   when
      faced  with  a broken nameserver that returns SERVFAIL
      (a temporary failure) on T_AAAA (IPv6) lookups  during
      hostname  canonification.   Notice: it might be neces-
      sary to apply the same (or similar)  options  to  sub-
      mit.cf too.

           Version  level  1 configurations (see the section
      about ``Configuration Version Level'') turn DNSRCH and
      DEFNAMES off when doing delivery  lookups,  but  leave
      them  on  everywhere  else.  Version 8 of sendmail ig-
      nores them when doing canonification lookups (that is,
      when using $[ ... $]), and always does the search.  If
      you don't want to do automatic name  extension,  don't
      call $[ ... $].

           The  search rules for $[ ... $] are somewhat dif-
      ferent than usual.  If the name being looked up has at
      least one dot, it always  tries  the  unmodified  name
      first.   If  that  fails,  it tries the reduced search










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-57


      path, and lastly tries the unmodified name  (but  only
      for  names  without a dot, since names with a dot have
      already  been  tried).   This  allows  names  such  as
      ``utc.CS''  to match the site in Czechoslovakia rather
      than the site in your local Computer  Science  depart-
      ment.   It  also  prefers  A and CNAME records over MX
      records -- that is, if it finds an MX record it  makes
      note  of it, but keeps looking.  This way, if you have
      a wildcard MX record matching your domain, it will not
      assume that all names match.

           To completely turn off all name server access  on
      systems  without service switch support (such as SunOS
      4.X) you will have to  recompile  with  -DNAMED_BIND=0
      and  remove  -lresolv from the list of libraries to be
      searched when linking.

   4.12.  Moving the Per-User Forward Files

           Some sites mount each user's home directory  from
      a  local  disk on their workstation, so that local ac-
      cess is fast.  However, the result  is  that  .forward
      file  lookups from a central mail server are slow.  In
      some cases, mail can even be delivered on machines in-
      appropriately because of a  file  server  being  down.
      The  performance  can be especially bad if you run the
      automounter.

           The ForwardPath (J) option allows you  to  set  a
      path  of  forward files.  For example, the config file
      line

          O ForwardPath=/var/forward/$u:$z/.forward.$w

      would first look for a file with the same name as  the
      user's login in /var/forward; if that is not found (or
      is  inaccessible) the file ``.forward.machinename'' in
      the user's home directory is searched.  A  truly  per-
      verse  site  could  also search by sender by using $r,
      $s, or $f.

           If you create a directory such  as  /var/forward,
      it should be mode 1777 (that is, the sticky bit should
      be  set).   Users  should  create the files mode 0644.
      Note that you must use the  ForwardFileInUnsafeDirPath
      and   ForwardFileInUnsafeDirPathSafe  flags  with  the
      DontBlameSendmail option to allow forward files  in  a
      world  writable directory.  This might also be used as
      a denial of service attack (users could create forward
      files for other users); a better approach might be  to
      create  /var/forward  mode 0755 and create empty files
      for each user, owned by that user, mode 0644.  If  you
      do  this,  you don't have to set the DontBlameSendmail










SMM:08-58          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      options indicated above.

   4.13.  Free Space

           On systems that have one of the system  calls  in
      the  statfs(2)  family  (including statvfs and ustat),
      you can specify a minimum number of free blocks on the
      queue filesystem using the MinFreeBlocks  (b)  option.
      If there are fewer than the indicated number of blocks
      free  on  the filesystem on which the queue is mounted
      the SMTP server will reject mail with  the  452  error
      code.   This  invites  the  SMTP  client  to try again
      later.

           Beware of setting this option too  high;  it  can
      cause  rejection  of  email  when  that  mail would be
      processed without difficulty.

   4.14.  Maximum Message Size

           To avoid overflowing your  system  with  a  large
      message,  the  MaxMessageSize option can be set to set
      an absolute limit on the  size  of  any  one  message.
      This  will  be  advertised  in  the ESMTP dialogue and
      checked during message collection.

   4.15.  Privacy Flags

           The PrivacyOptions (p) option allows you  to  set
      certain  ``privacy''  flags.   Actually,  many of them
      don't give you any extra privacy, rather just  insist-
      ing  that client SMTP servers use the HELO command be-
      fore using certain commands or adding extra headers to
      indicate possible spoof attempts.

           The option takes a series of flag names; the  fi-
      nal  privacy  is the inclusive or of those flags.  For
      example:

          O PrivacyOptions=needmailhelo, noexpn

      insists that the HELO or EHLO command be used before a
      MAIL command is accepted and disables  the  EXPN  com-
      mand.

           The flags are detailed in section 5.6.

   4.16.  Send to Me Too

           Beginning with version 8.10, sendmail includes by
      default  the (envelope) sender in any list expansions.
      For example, if "matt" sends to a list  that  contains
      "matt" as one of the members he will get a copy of the










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-59


      message.   If the MeToo option is set to FALSE (in the
      configuration file or via the command line), this  be-
      havior  is changed, i.e., the (envelope) sender is ex-
      cluded in list expansions.

5.  THE WHOLE SCOOP ON THE CONFIGURATION FILE

        This section describes the configuration file in de-
   tail.

        There is one point that should be made clear immedi-
   ately: the syntax of the configuration file  is  designed
   to  be reasonably easy to parse, since this is done every
   time sendmail starts up, rather than easy for a human  to
   read  or  write.  The configuration file should be gener-
   ated via the method described in cf/README, it should not
   be edited directly unless someone is  familiar  with  the
   internals of the syntax described here and it is not pos-
   sible  to  achieve  the  desired  result  via the default
   method.

        The configuration file is organized as a  series  of
   lines,  each  of  which  begins  with  a single character
   defining the semantics for the rest of the  line.   Lines
   beginning  with  a  space or a tab are continuation lines
   (although the semantics are  not  well  defined  in  many
   places).   Blank  lines  and lines beginning with a sharp
   symbol (`#') are comments.

   5.1.  R and S -- Rewriting Rules

           The core of address  parsing  are  the  rewriting
      rules.  These are an ordered production system.  Send-
      mail  scans through the set of rewriting rules looking
      for a match on the left hand side (LHS) of  the  rule.
      When  a  rule  matches, the address is replaced by the
      right hand side (RHS) of the rule.

           There are several sets of rewriting rules.   Some
      of  the  rewriting  sets  are used internally and must
      have specific semantics.  Other rewriting sets do  not
      have  specifically assigned semantics, and may be ref-
      erenced by the mailer definitions or by other  rewrit-
      ing sets.

           The syntax of these two commands are:

          Sn

      Sets the current ruleset being collected to n.  If you
      begin  a  ruleset more than once it appends to the old
      definition.











SMM:08-60          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


          Rlhs rhs comments

      The fields must be separated by at least one tab char-
      acter; there may be embedded  spaces  in  the  fields.
      The lhs is a pattern that is applied to the input.  If
      it  matches,  the  input is rewritten to the rhs.  The
      comments are ignored.

           Macro expansions of the  form  $x  are  performed
      when  the configuration file is read.  A literal $ can
      be included using $$.  Expansions of the form $&x  are
      performed  at  run  time using a somewhat less general
      algorithm.  This is intended only for referencing  in-
      ternally defined macros such as $h that are changed at
      runtime.

      5.1.1.  The left hand side

              The left hand side of rewriting rules contains
         a  pattern.   Normal  words  are simply matched di-
         rectly.  Metasyntax is introduced  using  a  dollar
         sign.  The metasymbols are:

             $*   Match zero or more tokens
             $+   Match one or more tokens
             $-   Match exactly one token
             $=x  Match any phrase in class x
             $~x  Match any word not in class x

         If  any  of  these  match, they are assigned to the
         symbol $n for replacement on the right  hand  side,
         where  n  is the index in the LHS.  For example, if
         the LHS:

             $-:$+

         is applied to the input:

             UCBARPA:eric

         the rule will match, and the values passed  to  the
         RHS will be:

             $1  UCBARPA
             $2  eric


              Additionally,  the LHS can include $@ to match
         zero tokens.  This is not bound to a $n on the RHS,
         and is normally only used when it stands  alone  in
         order to match the null input.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-61


      5.1.2.  The right hand side

              When  the  left  hand side of a rewriting rule
         matches, the input is deleted and replaced  by  the
         right  hand  side.  Tokens are copied directly from
         the RHS unless  they  begin  with  a  dollar  sign.
         Metasymbols are:

             $n         Substitute indefinite token n from LHS
             $[name$]   Canonicalize name
             $(map key $@arguments $:default $)
                        Generalized keyed mapping function
             $>n        "Call" ruleset n
             $#mailer   Resolve to mailer
             $@host     Specify host
             $:user     Specify user


              The  $n  syntax  substitutes the corresponding
         value from a $+, $-, $*, $=, or  $~  match  on  the
         LHS.  It may be used anywhere.

              A  host  name  enclosed  between  $[ and $] is
         looked up in the host database(s) and  replaced  by
         the canonical  name[14].   For  example,  "$[ftp$]"
         might      become     "ftp.CS.Berkeley.EDU"     and
         "$[[128.32.130.2]$]"     would     become     "van-
         gogh.CS.Berkeley.EDU."  Sendmail recognizes its nu-
         meric  IP  address  without calling the name server
         and replaces it with its canonical name.

              The $( ...  $) syntax is a more  general  form
         of  lookup;  it  uses a named map instead of an im-
         plicit map.  If no lookup is found,  the  indicated
         default is inserted; if no default is specified and
         no  lookup  matches,  the  value is left unchanged.
         The arguments are passed to the  map  for  possible
         use.

              The  $>n  syntax  causes  the remainder of the
         line to be substituted as usual and then passed  as
         the  argument  to  ruleset  n.   The final value of
         ruleset n then becomes the  substitution  for  this
         rule.   The  $> syntax expands everything after the
         ruleset name to the end of the  replacement  string
         and  then  passes  that as the initial input to the
         ruleset.  Recursive calls are allowed.   For  exam-
         ple,
____________________
   [14]This  is  actually  completely  equivalent  to $(host
hostname$).  In particular, a $: default can be used.












SMM:08-62          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


             $>0 $>3 $1

         expands  $1,  passes  that  to  ruleset 3, and then
         passes the result of ruleset 3 to ruleset 0.

              The $# syntax should only be used  in  ruleset
         zero,  a  subroutine  of  ruleset zero, or rulesets
         that  return  decisions  (e.g.,  check_rcpt).    It
         causes evaluation of the ruleset to terminate imme-
         diately,  and  signals to sendmail that the address
         has completely resolved.  The complete  syntax  for
         ruleset 0 is:

             $#mailer $@host $:user

         This  specifies  the  {mailer,  host, user} 3-tuple
         (triple) necessary to direct the mailer.  Note: the
         third element ( user ) is often also called address
         part.  If the mailer is local the host part may  be
         omitted[15].  The mailer must be a single word, but
         the host and user may be multi-part.  If the mailer
         is the built-in IPC mailer, the host may be a colon
         (or comma) separated list of hosts.  Each is  sepa-
         rately MX expanded and the results are concatenated
         to make (essentially) one long MX list.  Hosts sep-
         arated  by a comma have the same MX preference, and
         for each colon separated host the MX preference  is
         increased.   The  user  is  later  rewritten by the
         mailer-specific envelope rewriting set and assigned
         to the $u macro.  As a special case, if the  mailer
         specified  has the F=@ flag specified and the first
         character of the  $:  value  is  "@",  the  "@"  is
         stripped  off, and a flag is set in the address de-
         scriptor that causes sendmail to not do  ruleset  5
         processing.

              Normally, a rule that matches is retried, that
         is,  the rule loops until it fails.  A RHS may also
         be preceded by a $@ or a $: to change  this  behav-
         ior.  A $@ prefix causes the ruleset to return with
         the remainder of the RHS as the value.  A $: prefix
         causes  the  rule to terminate immediately, but the
         ruleset to continue; this can be used to avoid con-
         tinued  application  of  a  rule.   The  prefix  is
         stripped before continuing.

____________________
   [15]You  may want to use it for special "per user" exten-
sions.  For example, in the address  "jgm+foo@CMU.EDU";  the
"+foo"  part  is not part of the user name, and is passed to
the local mailer for local use.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-63


              The  $@ and $: prefixes may precede a $> spec;
         for example:

             R$+     $: $>7 $1

         matches anything, passes that to ruleset seven, and
         continues; the $: is necessary to avoid an infinite
         loop.

              Substitution occurs in  the  order  described,
         that  is,  parameters from the LHS are substituted,
         hostnames  are  canonicalized,  "subroutines"   are
         called, and finally $#, $@, and $: are processed.

      5.1.3.  Semantics of rewriting rule sets

              There  are  six  rewriting sets that have spe-
         cific semantics.  Five of these are related as  de-
         picted by figure 1.

              Ruleset  three  should  turn  the address into
         "canonical form."  This form should have the  basic
         syntax:

             local-part@host-domain-spec

         Ruleset  three  is applied by sendmail before doing
         anything with any address.



____________________________________________________________

                    +---+
                 -->| 0 |-->resolved address
                /   +---+
               /            +---+   +---+
              /        ---->| 1 |-->| S |--
       +---+ / +---+  /     +---+   +---+  \    +---+
addr-->| 3 |-->| D |--                      --->| 4 |-->msg
       +---+   +---+  \     +---+   +---+  /    +---+
                        --->| 2 |-->| R |--
                            +---+   +---+

            Figure 1 -- Rewriting set semantics
          D -- sender domain addition
          S -- mailer-specific sender rewriting
          R -- mailer-specific recipient rewriting
____________________________________________________________














SMM:08-64          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


              If no "@" sign is specified, then the host-do-
         main-spec may be appended (box  "D"  in  Figure  1)
         from  the  sender  address (if the C flag is set in
         the mailer definition corresponding to the  sending
         mailer).

              Ruleset zero is applied after ruleset three to
         addresses that are going to actually specify recip-
         ients.   It  must  resolve  to a {mailer, host, ad-
         dress} triple.  The mailer must be defined  in  the
         mailer  definitions  from  the  configuration file.
         The host is defined into the $h macro  for  use  in
         the  argv  expansion  of the specified mailer.  No-
         tice: since the envelope  sender  address  will  be
         used  if  a  delivery  status  notification must be
         send, i.e., it may specify a recipient, it is  also
         run  through ruleset zero.  If ruleset zero returns
         a temporary error 4xy then  delivery  is  deferred.
         This  can  be used to temporarily disable delivery,
         e.g., based on the time of the day or other varying
         parameters.  It should not be used to quarantine e-
         mails.

              Rulesets one and two are applied to all sender
         and recipient addresses respectively.  They are ap-
         plied before any specification in the mailer defin-
         ition.  They must never resolve.

              Ruleset four is applied to  all  addresses  in
         the message.  It is typically used to translate in-
         ternal to external form.

              In addition, ruleset 5 is applied to all local
         addresses  (specifically,  those  that resolve to a
         mailer with the `F=5' flag set) that  do  not  have
         aliases.   This allows a last minute hook for local
         names.

      5.1.4.  Ruleset hooks

              A few extra rulesets are  defined  as  "hooks"
         that  can be defined to get special features.  They
         are all named rulesets.  The  "check_*"  forms  all
         give  accept/reject  status; falling off the end or
         returning normally is an accept, and  resolving  to
         $#error is a reject or quarantine.  Quarantining is
         chosen  by specifying quarantine in the second part
         of the mailer triplet:

             $#error $@ quarantine $: Reason for quarantine

         Many of these  can  also  resolve  to  the  special
         mailer  name $#discard; this accepts the message as










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-65


         though it were  successful  but  then  discards  it
         without delivery.  Note, this mailer cannot be cho-
         sen  as  a mailer in ruleset 0.  Note also that all
         "check_*" rulesets  have  to  deal  with  temporary
         failures,  especially  for map lookups, themselves,
         i.e., they should return a temporary error code  or
         at  least  they  should  make  a proper decision in
         those cases.

         5.1.4.1.  check_relay

                 The check_relay ruleset is called  after  a
            connection is accepted by the daemon.  It is not
            called  when  sendmail  is started using the -bs
            option.  It is passed

                client.host.name $| client.host.address

            where $| is a metacharacter separating  the  two
            parts.  This ruleset can reject connections from
            various locations.  Note that it only checks the
            connecting  SMTP client IP address and hostname.
            It does not check for third party message relay-
            ing.  The  check_rcpt  ruleset  discussed  below
            usually does third party message relay checking.

         5.1.4.2.  check_mail

                 The  check_mail  ruleset is passed the user
            name parameter of the SMTP MAIL command.  It can
            accept or reject the address.

         5.1.4.3.  check_rcpt

                 The check_rcpt ruleset is passed  the  user
            name parameter of the SMTP RCPT command.  It can
            accept or reject the address.

         5.1.4.4.  check_data

                 The  check_data ruleset is called after the
            SMTP DATA command, its parameter is  the  number
            of recipients.  It can accept or reject the com-
            mand.

         5.1.4.5.  check_other

                 The  check_other ruleset is invoked for all
            unknown SMTP commands and for commands which  do
            not have specific rulesets, e.g., NOOP and VERB.
            Internal  checks, e.g., those explained in "Mea-
            sures against Denial of  Service  Attacks",  are
            performed first.  The ruleset is passed










SMM:08-66          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                entire-SMTP-command $| SMTP-reply-first-digit

            where  $|  is a metacharacter separating the two
            parts.  For example,

                VERB $| 2

            reflects receiving the "VERB" SMTP  command  and
            the intent to return a "2XX" SMTP success reply.
            Alternatively,

                JUNK TYPE=I $| 5

            reflects  receiving  the  unknown  "JUNK TYPE=I"
            SMTP command and the intent to  return  a  "5XX"
            SMTP  failure reply.  If the ruleset returns the
            SMTP reply code 421:

                $#error $@ 4.7.0 $: 421 bad command

            the session is terminated.  Note: it  is  a  bad
            idea to return the original command in the error
            text  to  the client as that might be abused for
            certain attacks.  The ruleset cannot override  a
            rejection triggered by the built-in rules.

         5.1.4.6.  check_compat

                 The check_compat ruleset is passed

                sender-address $| recipient-address

            where  $|  is a metacharacter separating the ad-
            dresses.  It can accept or reject mail  transfer
            between these two addresses much like the check-
            compat()  function.   Note:  while other check_*
            rulesets are invoked during the  SMTP  mail  re-
            ceiption  stage  (i.e.,  in  the  SMTP  server),
            check_compat is invoked during the mail delivery
            stage.

         5.1.4.7.  check_eoh

                 The check_eoh ruleset is passed

                number-of-headers $| size-of-headers

            where $| is a metacharacter separating the  num-
            bers.   These  numbers can be used for size com-
            parisons with the arith  map.   The  ruleset  is
            triggered  after  all  of  the headers have been
            read.  It can be used to  correlate  information
            gathered  from  those  headers  using  the macro










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-67


            storage map.  One possible use is to check for a
            missing header.  For example:

                Kstorage macro
                HMessage-Id: $>CheckMessageId

                SCheckMessageId
                # Record the presence of the header
                R$*            $: $(storage {MessageIdCheck} $@ OK $) $1
                R< $+ @ $+ >   $@ OK
                R$*            $#error $: 553 Header Error

                Scheck_eoh
                # Check the macro
                R$*            $: < $&{MessageIdCheck} >
                # Clear the macro for the next message
                R$*            $: $(storage {MessageIdCheck} $) $1
                # Has a Message-Id: header
                R< $+ >        $@ OK
                # Allow missing Message-Id: from local mail
                R$*            $: < $&{client_name} >
                R< >           $@ OK
                R< $=w >       $@ OK
                # Otherwise, reject the mail
                R$*            $#error $: 553 Header Error

            Keep in mind the Message-Id: header is not a re-
            quired header and is not a guaranteed spam indi-
            cator.  This ruleset is an  example  and  should
            probably not be used in production.

         5.1.4.8.  check_eom

                 The  check_eom  ruleset is called after the
            end of a message, its parameter is  the  message
            size.  It can accept or reject the message.

         5.1.4.9.  check_etrn

                 The  check_etrn ruleset is passed the para-
            meter of the SMTP ETRN command.  It  can  accept
            or reject the command.

         5.1.4.10.  check_expn

                 The  check_expn  ruleset is passed the user
            name parameter of the SMTP EXPN command.  It can
            accept or reject the address.

         5.1.4.11.  check_vrfy

                 The check_vrfy ruleset is passed  the  user
            name parameter of the SMTP VRFY command.  It can










SMM:08-68          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


            accept or reject the command.

         5.1.4.12.  clt_features

                 The clt_features ruleset is called with the
            server's  host  name before sendmail connects to
            it (only if sendmail is compiled  with  STARTTLS
            or  SASL).   This  ruleset should return $# fol-
            lowed by a list of options (in  general,  single
            characters  delimited  by  white space).  If the
            return value starts with  anything  else  it  is
            silently  ignored.  Generally upper case charac-
            ters turn off a feature while lower case charac-
            ters turn it  on.   Options  `D'/`M'  cause  the
            client  to  not  use DANE/MTA-STS, respectively,
            which is useful to interact with MTAs that  have
            broken  DANE/MTA-STS  setups by simply not using
            it.  Note: The d option in  tls_clt_features  to
            turn off DANE does not work when the server does
            not even offer STARTTLS.

         5.1.4.13.  trust_auth

                 The  trust_auth ruleset is passed the AUTH=
            parameter of the SMTP MAIL command.  It is  used
            to   determine  whether  this  value  should  be
            trusted. In order to  make  this  decision,  the
            ruleset  may  make  use of the various ${auth_*}
            macros.  If the ruleset does resolve to the "er-
            ror" mailer the AUTH= parameter is  not  trusted
            and hence not passed on to the next relay.

         5.1.4.14.  tls_client

                 The tls_client ruleset is called when send-
            mail  acts  as  server: after a STARTTLS command
            has been issued and the TLS handshake  was  per-
            formed,  and  from check_mail.  The parameter is
            the value of ${verify} and STARTTLS or MAIL, re-
            spectively.  If the ruleset does resolve to  the
            "error"  mailer,  the  appropriate error code is
            returned to the client, for STARTTLS  this  hap-
            pens for (most) subsequent commands.

         5.1.4.15.  tls_server

                 The tls_server ruleset is called when send-
            mail  acts  as  client  after a STARTTLS command
            (should) have been issued.  The parameter is the
            value of ${verify}.  If the ruleset does resolve
            to the "error" mailer, the connection is aborted
            (treated as non-deliverable with a permanent  or
            temporary error).










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-69


         5.1.4.16.  tls_rcpt

                 The  tls_rcpt  ruleset  is called each time
            before a RCPT command is sent.  The parameter is
            the current recipient.  If the ruleset does  re-
            solve to the "error" mailer, the RCPT command is
            suppressed  (treated  as  non-deliverable with a
            permanent or temporary error).  This ruleset al-
            lows to require encryption  or  verification  of
            the  recipient's MTA even if the mail is somehow
            redirected to another host.  For example,  send-
            ing  mail to luke@endmail.org may get redirected
            to  a  host  named  death.star  and  hence   the
            tls_server  ruleset won't apply.  By introducing
            per recipient restrictions such  attacks  (e.g.,
            via  DNS  spoofing) can be made impossible.  See
            cf/README how this ruleset can be used.

         5.1.4.17.  srv_features

                 The srv_features ruleset is called with the
            connecting client's host name when a client con-
            nects to sendmail.  This ruleset  should  return
            $#  followed  by  a list of options (in general,
            single characters delimited by white space).  If
            the return value starts with anything else it is
            silently ignored.  Generally upper case  charac-
            ters turn off a feature while lower case charac-
            ters  turn  it on.  Option `S' causes the server
            not to offer STARTTLS, which is useful to inter-
            act with MTAs/MUAs that have broken STARTTLS im-
            plementations by simply not  offering  it.   `V'
            turns  off  the request for a client certificate
            during the TLS handshake.  Options `A'  and  `P'
            suppress SMTP AUTH and PIPELINING, respectively.
            `c' is the equivalent to AuthOptions=p, i.e., it
            doesn't  permit mechanisms susceptible to simple
            passive attack (e.g., PLAIN,  LOGIN),  unless  a
            security  layer  is active.  Option `l' requires
            SMTP AUTH for a connection.  Options  'B',  'D',
            'E',  and 'X' suppress SMTP VERB, DSN, ETRN, and
            EXPN, respectively.  If a client  sends  one  of
            the  (HTTP) commands GET, POST, CONNECT, or USER
            the connection is immediately terminated in  the
            following  cases:  if  sent as first command, if
            sent as first command after STARTTLS, or if  the
            'h'  option  is  set.   Option 'F' disables SMTP
            transaction stuffing protection which is enabled
            by default.  The protection checks  for  clients
            which  try  to send commands without waiting for
            the server HELO/EHLO and DATA response.   Option
            'o' causes the server to accept only CRLF . CRLF
            as  end  of  an  SMTP message as required by the










SMM:08-70          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


            RFCs which is also a defense against SMTP  smug-
            gling  (CVE-2023-51765).   Option 'O' allows the
            server to accept a single dot on a line  by  it-
            self  as end of an SMTP message.  Option 'g' in-
            structs the server to fail SMTP  messages  which
            have a LF without a CR directly before it ("bare
            LF")  by  dropping the session with a 421 error.
            Option 'G' accepts SMTP messages  which  have  a
            "bare  LF".   Option 'u' instructs the server to
            fail SMTP messages which have a CR without a  LF
            directly  after  it  ("bare CR") by dropping the
            session with a 421 error.   Option  'U'  accepts
            SMTP  messages which have a "bare CR".  There is
            a variant for the options 'u' and 'g': a '2' can
            be appended to the single  character,  in  which
            case  the server will replace the offending bare
            CR or bare LF with a space.  This allows to  ac-
            cept  mail  from broken systems, but the message
            is modified to avoid SMTP smuggling.  If needed,
            systems with broken SMTP implementations can  be
            allowed some violations, e.g., a combination of

                G U g2 u2 O

            A command like

                egrep 'Bare.*(CR|LF).*not allowed' $MAILLOG

            can  be used to find hosts which send bare CR or
            LF.

































Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-71


                A        Do not offer AUTH
                a        Offer AUTH (default)
                B        Do not offer VERB
                b        Offer VERB (default)
                C        Do not require security layer for
                         plaintext AUTH (default)
                c        Require security layer for plaintext AUTH
                D        Do not offer DSN
                d        Offer DSN (default)
                E        Do not offer ETRN
                e        Offer ETRN (default)
                F        Disable transaction stuffing protection
                f        Enforce transaction stuffing protection (default)
                G        Accept "bare LF"s in a message
                g        Do not accept "bare LF"s in a message (default)
                g2       Replace "bare LF" in a message with space
                h        Terminate session after HTTP commands
                L        Do not require AUTH (default)
                l        Require AUTH
                O        Accept a single dot on a line by itself
                         as end of an SMTP message
                o        Require CRLF . CRLF as end of an SMTP message (default)
                P        Do not offer PIPELINING
                p        Offer PIPELINING (default)
                S        Do not offer STARTTLS
                s        Offer STARTTLS (default)
                U        Accept "bare CR"s in a message
                u        Do not accept "bare CR"s in a message (default)
                u2       Replace "bare CR" in a message with space
                V        Do not request a client certificate
                v        Request a client certificate (default)
                X        Do not offer EXPN
                x        Offer EXPN (default)

            Note: the entries marked  as  ``(default)''  may
            require  that  some configuration has been made,
            e.g., SMTP AUTH is only  available  if  properly
            configured.    Moreover,  many  options  can  be
            changed on a global basis via other settings  as
            explained in this document, e.g., via DaemonPor-
            tOptions.

                 The ruleset may return `$#temp' to indicate
            that  there  is  a temporary problem determining
            the correct features, e.g., if a map is unavail-
            able.  In that case, the SMTP  server  issues  a
            temporary failure and does not accept email.

         5.1.4.18.  try_tls

                 The try_tls ruleset is called when sendmail
            connects  to  another MTA.  The argument for the
            ruleset is the  name  of  the  server.   If  the










SMM:08-72          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


            ruleset  does  resolve  to  the  "error" mailer,
            sendmail does not try STARTTLS even if it is of-
            fered.  This is useful to deal with STARTTLS in-
            teroperability issues by simply not using it.

         5.1.4.19.  tls_srv_features and tls_clt_features

                 The  tls_clt_features  ruleset  is   called
            right  before  sendmail issues the STARTTLS com-
            mand to another  MTA  and  the  tls_srv_features
            ruleset is called when a client sends the START-
            TLS  command to sendmail.  The arguments for the
            rulesets are the host name and IP address of the
            other side separated by $| (which is a metachar-
            acter).  They should return a list of  key=value
            pairs  separated  by semicolons; the list can be
            empty if no options should  be  applied  to  the
            connection.   Available  keys  are and their al-
            lowed values are:

            Options
              A comma separated list of SSL related options.
              See ServerSSLOptions and ClientSSLOptions  for
              details,  as  well  as  SSL_set_options(3) and
              note this warning: Options already set  before
              are not cleared!

            CipherList
              Specify cipher list for STARTTLS (does not ap-
              ply  to  TLSv1.3), see ciphers(1) for possible
              values.  This overrides the global  CipherList
              for the session.

            CertFile
              File containing a certificate.

            KeyFile
              File  containing  the private key for the cer-
              tificate.

            Flags
              Currently the only valid flags are
              R to require a CRL for each  encountered  cer-
              tificate  during  verification  (by  default a
              missing CRL is ignored),
              c and C which basically clears/sets the option
              TLSFallbacktoClear for just this session,  re-
              spectively,
              d  to  turn  off  DANE which is obviously only
              valid for tls_clt_features and  requires  DANE
              to  be  compiled  in.  This might be needed in
              case of a misconfiguration,  e.g.,  specifying
              invalid TLSA RRs.










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-73


            Example:

                Stls_srv_features
                R$* $| 10.$+   $: cipherlist=HIGH


            Notes:

                 Errors  in  these  features  (e.g., unknown
            keys or invalid values) are logged and the  cur-
            rent  session is aborted to avoid using STARTTLS
            with features that should have been changed.

                 The keys are case-insensitive.

                 Both CertFile and KeyFile must be specified
            together; specifying only one is an error.

         5.1.4.20.  authinfo

                 The authinfo ruleset is called  when  send-
            mail  tries to authenticate to another MTA.  The
            arguments for the ruleset are the host name  and
            IP  address of the server separated by $| (which
            is a metacharacter).  It should return  $#  fol-
            lowed by a list of tokens that are used for SMTP
            AUTH.   If the return value starts with anything
            else it is silently ignored.  Each  token  is  a
            tagged string of the form: "TDstring" (including
            the quotes), where

                T        Tag which describes the item
                D        Delimiter: ':' simple text follows
                         '=' string is base64 encoded
                string   Value of the item

            Valid values for the tag are:

                U        user (authorization) id
                I        authentication id
                P        password
                R        realm
                M        list of mechanisms delimited by spaces

            If  this ruleset is defined, the option Default-
            AuthInfo is ignored (even if  the  ruleset  does
            not return a ``useful'' result).

         5.1.4.21.  queuegroup

                 The queuegroup ruleset is used to map a re-
            cipient  address to a queue group name.  The in-
            put for the ruleset  is  the  recipient  address










SMM:08-74          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


            (i.e.,  the address part of the resolved triple)
            The ruleset should return  $#  followed  by  the
            name  of  a  queue  group.   If the return value
            starts with anything else  it  is  silently  ig-
            nored.  See the section about ``Queue Groups and
            Queue Directories'' for further information.

         5.1.4.22.  greet_pause

                 The  greet_pause ruleset is used to specify
            the amount of time to pause before  sending  the
            initial  SMTP  220  greeting.  The arguments for
            the ruleset are the host name and IP address  of
            the client separated by $| (which is a metachar-
            acter).   If any traffic is received during that
            pause, an SMTP 554 rejection response  is  given
            instead  of  the  220 greeting and all SMTP com-
            mands are rejected during that connection.  This
            helps protect sites from open proxies  and  SMTP
            slammers.  The ruleset should return $# followed
            by  the number of milliseconds (thousandths of a
            second) to pause.  If the  return  value  starts
            with  anything  else  or  is not a number, it is
            silently ignored.  Note: this ruleset is not in-
            voked (and hence the feature is  disabled)  when
            smtps (SMTP over SSL) is used, i.e., the s modi-
            fier  is  set  for  the daemon via DaemonPortOp-
            tions, because in this case the SSL handshake is
            performed before the greeting is sent.

      5.1.5.  IPC mailers

              Some special processing occurs if the  ruleset
         zero  resolves  to an IPC mailer (that is, a mailer
         that has "[IPC]" listed as the Path in the  M  con-
         figuration  line.   The host name passed after "$@"
         has MX expansion performed if not delivering via  a
         named socket; this looks the name up in DNS to find
         alternate delivery sites.

              The host name can also be provided as a dotted
         quad or an IPv6 address in square brackets; for ex-
         ample:

             [128.32.149.78]

         or

             [IPv6:2002:c0a8:51d2::23f4]

         This  causes direct conversion of the numeric value
         to an IP host address.











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-75


              The host name passed in  after  the  "$@"  may
         also  be  a colon or comma separated list of hosts.
         Each is separately MX expanded and the results  are
         concatenated  to  make  (essentially)  one  long MX
         list.  Hosts separated by a comma have the same  MX
         preference,  and  for each colon separated host the
         MX preference is increased.  The intent here is  to
         create  "fake" MX records that are not published in
         DNS for private internal networks.

              As a final special case, the host name can  be
         passed in as a text string in square brackets:

             [ucbvax.berkeley.edu]

         This form avoids the MX mapping.  N.B.: This is in-
         tended only for situations where you have a network
         firewall  or  other  host that will do special pro-
         cessing for all your mail, so that your  MX  record
         points  to  a  gateway  machine; this machine could
         then do direct delivery to machines within your lo-
         cal domain.  Use of this feature directly  violates
         RFC  1123  section  5.3.5:  it  should  not be used
         lightly.

   5.2.  D -- Define Macro

           Macros are named with a single character or  with
      a  word  in {braces}.  The names ``x'' and ``{x}'' de-
      note the same macro for every single character  ``x''.
      Single character names may be selected from the entire
      ASCII  set, but user-defined macros should be selected
      from the set of upper case letters only.   Lower  case
      letters and special symbols are used internally.  Long
      names beginning with a lower case letter or a punctua-
      tion  character  are  reserved for use by sendmail, so
      user-defined long macro names should begin with an up-
      per case letter.

           The syntax for macro definitions is:

          Dxval

      where x is the name of the macro (which may be a  sin-
      gle  character  or  a  word  in braces) and val is the
      value it should have.  There should be no spaces given
      that do not actually belong in the macro value.

           Macros are interpolated using the  construct  $x,
      where  x  is the name of the macro to be interpolated.
      This interpolation is done when the configuration file
      is read, except in M lines.  The special construct $&x
      can be used in R lines to get deferred interpolation.










SMM:08-76          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


           Conditionals can be specified using the syntax:

          $?x text1 $| text2 $.

      This interpolates text1 if the macro  $x  is  set  and
      non-null, and text2 otherwise.  The "else" ($|) clause
      may be omitted.

           The  following macros are defined and/or used in-
      ternally by sendmail for interpolation into argv's for
      mailers or for other contexts.  The ones marked *  are
      information  passed into sendmail[16], the ones marked
      # are information passed both in and out of  sendmail,
      and the unmarked macros are passed out of sendmail but
      are not otherwise used internally.  These macros are:

      $a   The  origination date in RFC 822 format.  This is
           extracted from the Date: line.

      $b   The current date in RFC 822 format.

      $c   The hop count.  This is a count of the number  of
           Received:  lines plus the value of the -h command
           line flag.

      $d   The current date in UNIX (ctime) format.

      $e*  (Obsolete;  use  SmtpGreetingMessage  option  in-
           stead.)  The SMTP entry message.  This is printed
           out  when SMTP starts up.  The first word must be
           the $j macro as specified by RFC  821.   Defaults
           to  "$j Sendmail $v ready at $b".  Commonly rede-
           fined to include the configuration  version  num-
           ber, e.g., "$j Sendmail $v/$Z ready at $b"

      $f   The envelope sender (from) address.

      $g   The  sender  address  relative  to the recipient.
           For  example,  if  $f  is  "foo",  $g   will   be
           "host!foo", "foo@host.domain", or whatever is ap-
           propriate for the receiving mailer.

      $h   The  recipient  host.   This  is set in ruleset 0
           from the $@ field of a parsed address.

      $i   The queue id, e.g., "f344MXxp018717".

____________________
   [16]As  of  version 8.6, all of these macros have reason-
able defaults.  Previous versions required that they be  de-
fined.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-77


      $j#  The "official" domain name for this  site.   This
           is  fully qualified if the full qualification can
           be found.  It must be redefined to be  the  fully
           qualified  domain name if your system is not con-
           figured so that information can find it automati-
           cally.

      $k   The UUCP node name (from the uname system call).

      $l*  (Obsolete; use UnixFromLine option instead.)  The
           format of the UNIX from line.   Unless  you  have
           changed  the  UNIX mailbox format, you should not
           change the default, which is "From $g $d".

      $m   The domain part of the gethostname return  value.
           Under  normal  circumstances, $j is equivalent to
           $w.$m.

      $n*  The name of the daemon (for error messages).  De-
           faults to "MAILER-DAEMON".

      $o*  (Obsolete:  use  OperatorChars  option  instead.)
           The  set  of "operators" in addresses.  A list of
           characters which will be  considered  tokens  and
           which  will  separate  tokens when doing parsing.
           For example, if "@" were in the  $o  macro,  then
           the input "a@b" would be scanned as three tokens:
           "a," "@," and "b."  Defaults to ".:@[]", which is
           the  minimum set necessary to do RFC 822 parsing;
           a richer set of operators  is  ".:%@!/[]",  which
           adds  support for UUCP, the %-hack, and X.400 ad-
           dresses.

      $p   Sendmail's process id.

      $r   Protocol used to receive the message.   Set  from
           the  -p  command  line flag or by the SMTP server
           code.

      $s   Sender's host name.  Set from the -p command line
           flag or by the SMTP server code (in which case it
           is set to the EHLO/HELO parameter).

      $t   A numeric representation of the current  time  in
           the  format YYYYMMDDHHmm (4 digit year 1900-9999,
           2 digit month 01-12, 2 digit day 01-31,  2  digit
           hours 00-23, 2 digit minutes 00-59).

      $u   The recipient user.

      $v   The version number of the sendmail binary.












SMM:08-78          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      $w#  The hostname of this site.  This is the root name
           of this host (but see below for caveats).

      $x   The full name of the sender.

      $z   The home directory of the recipient.

      $_   The   validated   sender   address.    See   also
           ${client_resolve}.

      ${addr_type}
           The type of the address which is currently  being
           rewritten.  This macro contains up to three char-
           acters,  the first is either `e' or `h' for enve-
           lope/header address, the second is a  space,  and
           the third is either `s' or `r' for sender/recipi-
           ent address.

      ${alg_bits}
           The  maximum keylength (in bits) of the symmetric
           encryption algorithm used for a  TLS  connection.
           This  may  be  less than the effective keylength,
           which is stored in ${cipher_bits},  for  ``export
           controlled'' algorithms.

      ${auth_authen}
           The client's authentication credentials as deter-
           mined by authentication (only set if successful).
           The  format  depends  on  the  mechanism used, it
           might be just `user', or `user@realm',  or  some-
           thing similar (SMTP AUTH only).

      ${auth_author}
           The  authorization identity, i.e. the AUTH= para-
           meter of the SMTP MAIL command if supplied.

      ${auth_type}
           The mechanism used for SMTP authentication  (only
           set if successful).

      ${auth_ssf}
           The  keylength (in bits) of the symmetric encryp-
           tion algorithm used for the security layer  of  a
           SASL mechanism.

      ${bodytype}
           The  message body type (7BIT or 8BITMIME), as de-
           termined from the envelope.

      ${cert_fp}
           The  fingerprint  of  the  presented  certificate
           (STARTTLS  only).   Note:  this macro is only de-
           fined if the option  CertFingerprintAlgorithm  is










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-79


           set,  in which case the specified fingerprint al-
           gorithm is used.  The valid algorithms depend  on
           the  OpenSSL  version, but usually md5, sha1, and
           sha256 are available.  See

               openssl dgst -h

           for a list.

      ${cert_issuer}
           The DN (distinguished name) of the  CA  (certifi-
           cate  authority)  that  signed the presented cer-
           tificate (the cert issuer) (STARTTLS only).

      ${cert_md5}
           The MD5 hash of the presented certificate (START-
           TLS only).  Note: this macro is only  defined  if
           the option CertFingerprintAlgorithm is not set.

      ${cert_subject}
           The  DN  of the presented certificate (called the
           cert subject) (STARTTLS only).

      ${cipher}
           The cipher suite used for the  connection,  e.g.,
           EDH-DSS-DES-CBC3-SHA,  EDH-RSA-DES-CBC-SHA,  DES-
           CBC-MD5, DES-CBC3-SHA (STARTTLS only).

      ${cipher_bits}
           The effective keylength (in bits) of the  symmet-
           ric  encryption  algorithm used for a TLS connec-
           tion.

      ${client_addr}
           The IP address of  the  SMTP  client.   IPv6  ad-
           dresses  are  tagged  with "IPv6:" before the ad-
           dress.  Defined in the SMTP server only.

      ${client_connections}
           The number of open connections in the SMTP server
           for the client IP address.

      ${client_flags}
           The flags specified  by  the  Modifier=  part  of
           ClientPortOptions  where flags are separated from
           each other by spaces and  upper  case  flags  are
           doubled.   That  is,  Modifier=hA  will be repre-
           sented as "h AA" in ${client_flags}, which is re-
           quired for testing the flags in rulesets.

      ${client_name}
           The host name of the SMTP client.   This  may  be
           the  client's  bracketed IP address in the form [










SMM:08-80          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


           nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn    ]    for    IPv4     and     [
           IPv6:nnnn:...:nnnn  ] for IPv6 if the client's IP
           address is not resolvable, or if it is resolvable
           but the  IP  address  of  the  resolved  hostname
           doesn't  match  the original IP address.  Defined
           in the SMTP server only.  See  also  ${client_re-
           solve}.

      ${client_port}
           The  port  number of the SMTP client.  Defined in
           the SMTP server only.

      ${client_ptr}
           The result of the PTR lookup for  the  client  IP
           address.     Note:    this   is   the   same   as
           ${client_name} if and only  if  ${client_resolve}
           is OK.  Defined in the SMTP server only.

      ${client_rate}
           The number of incoming connections for the client
           IP  address  over  the time interval specified by
           ConnectionRateWindowSize.

      ${client_resolve}
           Holds  the  result  of  the  resolve   call   for
           ${client_name}.  Possible values are:

               OK        resolved successfully
               FAIL      permanent lookup failure
               FORGED    forward lookup doesn't match reverse lookup
               TEMP      temporary lookup failure

           Defined  in  the SMTP server only.  sendmail per-
           forms a hostname lookup on the IP address of  the
           connecting client.  Next the IP addresses of that
           hostname are looked up.  If the client IP address
           does  not  appear in that list, then the hostname
           is maybe forged.  This is reflected as the  value
           FORGED for ${client_resolve} and it also shows up
           in $_ as "(may be forged)".

      ${cn_issuer}
           The  CN  (common  name) of the CA that signed the
           presented certificate (STARTTLS only).  Note:  if
           the  CN  cannot  be extracted properly it will be
           replaced by one of these strings based on the en-
           countered error:

               BadCertificateContainsNULCN contains a NUL character
               BadCertificateTooLong    CN is too long
               BadCertificateUnknown    CN could not be extracted

           In the last case, some other  (unspecific)  error










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-81


           occurred.

      ${cn_subject}
           The CN (common name) of the presented certificate
           (STARTTLS  only).   See ${cn_issuer} for possible
           replacements.

      ${currHeader}
           Header value as quoted string (possibly truncated
           to MAXNAME).  This macro  is  only  available  in
           header check rulesets.

      ${daemon_addr}
           The  IP  address  the  daemon is listening on for
           connections.

      ${daemon_family}
           The network family if  the  daemon  is  accepting
           network  connections.   Possible  values  include
           "inet", "inet6", "iso", "ns", "x.25"

      ${daemon_flags}
           The flags for the daemon as specified by the Mod-
           ifier=  part  of  DaemonPortOptions  whereby  the
           flags  are  separated  from each other by spaces,
           and upper case flags are doubled.  That is, Modi-
           fier=Ea will be represented as "EE a"  in  ${dae-
           mon_flags},  which  is  required  for testing the
           flags in rulesets.

      ${daemon_info}
           Some information about a daemon as a text string.
           For example, "SMTP+queueing@00:30:00".

      ${daemon_name}
           The name of  the  daemon  from  DaemonPortOptions
           Name=  suboption.   If this suboption is not set,
           "Daemon#", where # is the daemon number, is used.

      ${daemon_port}
           The port the daemon is accepting  connection  on.
           Unless  DaemonPortOptions  is set, this will most
           likely be "25".

      ${deliveryMode}
           The current delivery mode sendmail is using.   It
           is initially set to the value of the DeliveryMode
           option.

      ${dsn_envid}
           The  envelope  id  parameter  (ENVID=)  passed to
           sendmail as part of the envelope.











SMM:08-82          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      ${dsn_notify}
           Value of DSN NOTIFY= parameter  (never,  success,
           failure, delay, or empty string).

      ${dsn_ret}
           Value of DSN RET= parameter (hdrs, full, or empty
           string).

      ${envid}
           The  envelope  id  parameter  (ENVID=)  passed to
           sendmail as part of the envelope.

      ${hdrlen}
           The length of the header value which is stored in
           ${currHeader} (before possible  truncation).   If
           this  value  is  greater than or equal to MAXNAME
           the header has been truncated.

      ${hdr_name}
           The name of the header field for which  the  cur-
           rent  header check ruleset has been called.  This
           is useful for a default header check  ruleset  to
           get  the  name  of  the header; the macro is only
           available in header check rulesets.

      ${if_addr}
           The IP address of the interface  of  an  incoming
           connection  unless  it  is  in  the loopback net.
           IPv6 addresses are tagged with "IPv6:" before the
           address.

      ${if_addr_out}
           The IP address of the interface  of  an  outgoing
           connection  unless  it  is  in  the loopback net.
           IPv6 addresses are tagged with "IPv6:" before the
           address.

      ${if_family}
           The IP family of the  interface  of  an  incoming
           connection unless it is in the loopback net.

      ${if_family_out}
           The  IP  family  of  the interface of an outgoing
           connection unless it is in the loopback net.

      ${if_name}
           The hostname associated with the interface of  an
           incoming  connection.  This macro can be used for
           SmtpGreetingMessage  and  HReceived  for  virtual
           hosting.  For example:

               O SmtpGreetingMessage=$?{if_name}${if_name}$|$j$. MTA











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-83


      ${if_name_out}
           The  name of the interface of an outgoing connec-
           tion.

      ${load_avg}
           The current load average.

      ${mail_addr}
           The address part of the resolved  triple  of  the
           address given for the SMTP MAIL command.  Defined
           in the SMTP server only.

      ${mail_host}
           The  host from the resolved triple of the address
           given for the SMTP MAIL command.  Defined in  the
           SMTP server only.

      ${mail_mailer}
           The  mailer  from  the resolved triple of the ad-
           dress given for the SMTP MAIL  command.   Defined
           in the SMTP server only.

      ${msg_id}
           The value of the Message-Id: header.

      ${msg_size}
           The  value  of the SIZE= parameter, i.e., usually
           the size of the message (in an  ESMTP  dialogue),
           before the message has been collected, thereafter
           the message size as computed by sendmail (and can
           be used in check_compat).

      ${nbadrcpts}
           The  number  of  bad recipients for a single mes-
           sage.

      ${nrcpts}
           The number of validated recipients for  a  single
           message.   Note:  since recipient validation hap-
           pens after check_rcpt has been called, the  value
           in  this  ruleset  is one less than what might be
           expected.

      ${ntries}
           The number of delivery attempts.

      ${opMode}
           The current operation mode (from the -b flag).

      ${quarantine}
           The quarantine reason for the envelope, if it  is
           quarantined.











SMM:08-84          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      ${queue_interval}
           The queue run interval given by the -q flag.  For
           example,  -q30m  would  set  ${queue_interval} to
           "00:30:00".

      ${rcpt_addr}
           The address part of the resolved  triple  of  the
           address given for the SMTP RCPT command.  Defined
           in the SMTP server only after a RCPT command.

      ${rcpt_host}
           The  host from the resolved triple of the address
           given for the SMTP RCPT command.  Defined in  the
           SMTP server only after a RCPT command.

      ${rcpt_mailer}
           The  mailer  from  the resolved triple of the ad-
           dress given for the SMTP RCPT  command.   Defined
           in the SMTP server only after a RCPT command.

      ${server_addr}
           The address of the server of the current outgoing
           SMTP  connection.  For LMTP delivery the macro is
           set to the name of the mailer.  (only if sendmail
           is compiled with STARTTLS or SASL.)

      ${server_name}
           The name of the server of  the  current  outgoing
           SMTP  or  LMTP  connection.  (only if sendmail is
           compiled with STARTTLS or SASL.)

      ${time}
           The output of the  time(3)  function,  i.e.,  the
           number  of  seconds  since  0 hours, 0 minutes, 0
           seconds, January 1, 1970,  Coordinated  Universal
           Time (UTC).

      ${tls_version}
           The  TLS/SSL  version  used  for  the connection,
           e.g., TLSv1.2, TLSv1; defined after STARTTLS  has
           been used.

      ${total_rate}
           The total number of incoming connections over the
           time  interval specified by ConnectionRateWindow-
           Size.

      ${verify}
           The result of the verification of  the  presented
           cert;  only  defined after STARTTLS has been used
           (or attempted).  Possible values are:












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-85


               TRUSTED      verification via DANE succeeded.
               DANE_FAIL    verification via DANE failed.
               DANE_TEMP    verification via DANE failed temporarily.
               DANE_NOTLS   DANE required but STARTTLS was not available.
               OK           verification succeeded.
               NO           no cert presented.
               NOT          no cert requested.
               FAIL         cert presented but could not be verified,
                            e.g., the signing CA is missing.
               NONE         STARTTLS has not been performed.
               CLEAR        STARTTLS has been disabled internally
                            for a clear text delivery attempt.
               TEMP         temporary error occurred.
               PROTOCOL     some protocol error occurred
                            at the ESMTP level (not TLS).
               CONFIG       tls_*_features failed due to a syntax error.
               SOFTWARE     STARTTLS handshake failed,
                            which is a fatal error for this session,
                            the e-mail will be queued.


           There are three types of dates that can be  used.
      The  $a and $b macros are in RFC 822 format; $a is the
      time as extracted from the "Date:" line of the message
      (if there was one), and $b is  the  current  date  and
      time  (used  for  postmarks).   If  no "Date:" line is
      found in the incoming message, $a is set to  the  cur-
      rent  time also.  The $d macro is equivalent to the $b
      macro in UNIX (ctime) format.

           The macros $w, $j, and $m are set to the identity
      of this host.  Sendmail tries to find the fully quali-
      fied name of the host if at all possible; it does this
      by calling gethostname(2) to get the current  hostname
      and  then  passing  that  to gethostbyname(3) which is
      supposed to return the canonical version of that  host
      name.[17] Assuming this is successful, $j  is  set  to
      the  fully  qualified name and $m is set to the domain
      part of the name (everything  after  the  first  dot).
      The  $w macro is set to the first word (everything be-
      fore the first dot) if you have a level  5  or  higher
      configuration  file;  otherwise, it is set to the same
      value as $j.  If the canonification is not successful,
      it is imperative that the config file set  $j  to  the
      fully qualified domain name[18].
____________________
   [17]For example, on some systems gethostname might return
"foo"  which  would be mapped to "foo.bar.com" by gethostby-
name.
   [18]Older  versions  of  sendmail didn't pre-define $j at
all, so up until 8.6, config files always had to define $j.












SMM:08-86          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


           The $f macro is the id of the  sender  as  origi-
      nally  determined; when mailing to a specific host the
      $g macro is set to the address of the sender  relative
      to  the  recipient.   For  example, if I send to "bol-
      lard@matisse.CS.Berkeley.EDU" from the  machine  "van-
      gogh.CS.Berkeley.EDU"  the $f macro will be "eric" and
      the $g macro will be "eric@vangogh.CS.Berkeley.EDU."

           The $x macro is set  to  the  full  name  of  the
      sender.   This  can be determined in several ways.  It
      can be passed as flag to sendmail.  It can be  defined
      in the NAME environment variable.  The third choice is
      the value of the "Full-Name:" line in the header if it
      exists,  and the fourth choice is the comment field of
      a "From:" line.  If all of these fail, and if the mes-
      sage is being originated locally,  the  full  name  is
      looked up in the /etc/passwd file.

           When  sending,  the $h, $u, and $z macros get set
      to the host, user, and home directory  (if  local)  of
      the  recipient.  The first two are set from the $@ and
      $: part of the rewriting rules, respectively.

           The $p and $t macros are used  to  create  unique
      strings  (e.g.,  for the "Message-Id:" field).  The $i
      macro is set to the queue id on this host; if put into
      the timestamp line it  can  be  extremely  useful  for
      tracking messages.  The $v macro is set to be the ver-
      sion number of sendmail; this is normally put in time-
      stamps and has been proven extremely useful for debug-
      ging.

           The $c field is set to the "hop count," i.e., the
      number of times this message has been processed.  This
      can  be  determined by the -h flag on the command line
      or by counting the timestamps in the message.

           The $r and $s fields are set to the protocol used
      to communicate with sendmail and the sending hostname.
      They can be set together using  the  -p  command  line
      flag or separately using the -M or -oM flags.

           The  $_  is  set to a validated sender host name.
      If the sender is running an RFC 1413  compliant  IDENT
      server  and the receiver has the IDENT protocol turned
      on, it will include the user name on that host.

           The    ${client_name},    ${client_addr},     and
      ${client_port}  macros  are  set to the name, address,
      and port number of the SMTP  client  who  is  invoking
      sendmail  as  a  server.   These  can  be  used in the
      check_* rulesets (using  the  $&  deferred  evaluation
      form, of course!).










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-87


   5.3.  C and F -- Define Classes

           Classes of phrases may be defined to match on the
      left hand side of rewriting rules, where a "phrase" is
      a  sequence  of characters that does not contain space
      characters.  For example a class of  all  local  names
      for  this  site  might  be created so that attempts to
      send to oneself can be eliminated.  These  can  either
      be  defined directly in the configuration file or read
      in from another file.  Classes are named as  a  single
      letter  or  a word in {braces}.  Class names beginning
      with lower case letters and special characters are re-
      served for system  use.   Classes  defined  in  config
      files  may  be  given names from the set of upper case
      letters for short names or  beginning  with  an  upper
      case letter for long names.

           The syntax is:

          Ccphrase1 phrase2...
          Fcfile
          Fc|program
          Fc[mapkey]@mapclass:mapspec

      The first form defines the class c to match any of the
      named  words.  If phrase1 or phrase2 is another class,
      e.g., $=S, the contents of class S are added to  class
      c.   It  is  permissible  to split them among multiple
      lines; for example, the two forms:

          CHmonet ucbmonet

      and

          CHmonet
          CHucbmonet

      are equivalent.  The ``F'' forms read the elements  of
      the class c from the named file, program, or map spec-
      ification.   Each  element should be listed on a sepa-
      rate line.  To specify an optional  file,  use  ``-o''
      between the class name and the file name, e.g.,

          Fc -o /path/to/file

      If  the file can't be used, sendmail will not complain
      but silently ignore it.  The map form should be an op-
      tional map key, an at sign, and a map  class  followed
      by the specification for that map.  Examples include:

          F{VirtHosts}@ldap:-k (&(objectClass=virtHosts)(host=*)) -v host
          F{MyClass}foo@hash:/etc/mail/classes











SMM:08-88          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      will  fill  the  class  $={VirtHosts} from an LDAP map
      lookup and $={MyClass} from a hash database map lookup
      of the key foo.  There is also a built-in schema  that
      can be accessed by only specifying:

          F{ClassName}@LDAP

      This will tell sendmail to use the default schema:

          -k (&(objectClass=sendmailMTAClass)
               (sendmailMTAClassName=ClassName)
               (|(sendmailMTACluster=${sendmailMTACluster})
                 (sendmailMTAHost=$j)))
          -v sendmailMTAClassValue

      Note  that  the  lookup  is only done when sendmail is
      initially started.

           Elements of classes can be accessed in rules  us-
      ing  $=  or  $~.   The $~ (match entries not in class)
      only matches a single word; multi-word entries in  the
      class are ignored in this context.

           Some classes have internal meaning to sendmail:

      $=e  contains  the Content-Transfer-Encodings that can
           be 8->7 bit encoded.  It is predefined to contain
           "7bit", "8bit", and "binary".

      $=k  set to be the same as $k, that is, the UUCP  node
           name.

      $=m  set  to  the set of domains by which this host is
           known, initially just $m.

      $=n  can be set to the set of MIME body types that can
           never be eight to seven bit encoded.  It defaults
           to "multipart/signed".  Message types "message/*"
           and "multipart/*"  are  never  encoded  directly.
           Multipart  messages  are  always  handled  recur-
           sively.  The handling of message/*  messages  are
           controlled by class $=s.

      $=q  A set of Content-Types that will never be encoded
           as  base64 (if they have to be encoded, they will
           be encoded as  quoted-printable).   It  can  have
           primary  types (e.g., "text") or full types (such
           as "text/plain").

      $=s  contains the set of subtypes of message that  can
           be  treated  recursively.  By default it contains
           only "rfc822".  Other "message/*" types cannot be
           8->7 bit encoded.  If a message containing  eight










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-89


           bit  data  is  sent to a seven bit host, and that
           message cannot be encoded  into  seven  bits,  it
           will be stripped to 7 bits.

      $=t  set to the set of trusted users by the T configu-
           ration  line.   If you want to read trusted users
           from a file, use Ft/file/name.

      $=w  set to be the set of all names this host is known
           by.  This can be used to match local hostnames.

      $={persistentMacros}
           set to the macros that  should  be  saved  across
           queue  runs.   Care  should  be taken when adding
           macro names to this class.

           Sendmail can be  compiled  to  allow  a  scanf(3)
      string  on  the  F  line.  This lets you do simplistic
      parsing of text files.  For example, to read  all  the
      user  names  in  your  system  /etc/passwd file into a
      class, use

          FL/etc/passwd %[^:]

      which reads every line up to the first colon.

   5.4.  E -- Set or Propagate Environment Variables

           E configuration lines set or  propagate  environ-
      ment variables into children.

          Ename

      will propagate the named variable from the environment
      when sendmail was invoked into any children it calls;

          Ename=value

      sets  the  named variable to the indicated value.  Any
      variables not explicitly named  will  not  be  in  the
      child environment.

   5.5.  M -- Define Mailer

           Programs and interfaces to mailers are defined in
      this line.  The format is:

          Mname, {field=value}*

      where  name is the name of the mailer (used internally
      only) and the "field=name" pairs define attributes  of
      the mailer.  Fields are:











SMM:08-90          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


          Path      The pathname of the mailer
          Flags     Special flags for this mailer
          Sender    Rewriting set(s) for sender addresses
          Recipient Rewriting set(s) for recipient addresses
          recipientsMaximum number of recipients per envelope
          Argv      An argument vector to pass to this mailer
          Eol       The end-of-line string for this mailer
          Maxsize   The maximum message length to this mailer
          maxmessagesThe maximum message deliveries per connection
          Linelimit The maximum line length in the message body
          Directory The working directory for the mailer
          Userid    The default user and group id to run as
          Nice      The nice(2) increment for the mailer
          Charset   The default character set for 8-bit characters
          Type      Type information for DSN diagnostics
          Wait      The maximum time to wait for the mailer
          QueuegroupThe default queue group for the mailer
          /         The root directory for the mailer

      Only  the first character of the field name is checked
      (it's case-sensitive).

           The following flags may be set in the mailer  de-
      scription.  Any other flags may be used freely to con-
      ditionally  assign  headers  to  messages destined for
      particular mailers.  Flags marked with * are  not  in-
      terpreted  by  the sendmail binary; these are the con-
      ventionally used to correlate to the flags portion  of
      the  H line.  Flags marked with # apply to the mailers
      for the sender address rather than the usual recipient
      mailers.

      a   Run Extended SMTP  (ESMTP)  protocol  (defined  in
          RFCs 1869, 1652, and 1870).  This flag defaults on
          if  the  SMTP  greeting  message includes the word
          "ESMTP".

      A   Look up the user (address) part  of  the  resolved
          mailer  triple,  in  the alias database.  Normally
          this is only set for local mailers.

      b   Force a blank line on the end of a message.   This
          is intended to work around some stupid versions of
          /bin/mail  that  require  a blank line, but do not
          provide it themselves.  It would not  normally  be
          used on network mail.

      B   Strip  leading backslashes (\) off of the address;
          this is a subset of the  functionality  of  the  s
          flag.

      c   Do not include comments in addresses.  This should
          only  be  used if you have to work around a remote










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-91


          mailer  that  gets  confused  by  comments.   This
          strips addresses of the form "Phrase <address>" or
          "address (Comment)" down to just "address".

      C#  If  mail  is received from a mailer with this flag
          set, any addresses in the header that do not  have
          an  at sign ("@") after being rewritten by ruleset
          three will have  the  "@domain"  clause  from  the
          sender  envelope  address  tacked on.  This allows
          mail with headers of the form:

              From: usera@hosta
              To: userb@hostb, userc

          to be rewritten as:

              From: usera@hosta
              To: userb@hostb, userc@hosta

          automatically.  However, it  doesn't  really  work
          reliably.

      d   Do not include angle brackets around route-address
          syntax  addresses.  This is useful on mailers that
          are going to pass addresses to a shell that  might
          interpret angle brackets as I/O redirection.  How-
          ever,  it  does  not  protect  against other shell
          metacharacters.  Therefore, passing addresses to a
          shell should not be considered secure.

      D*  This mailer wants a "Date:" header line.

      e   This mailer is expensive to connect to, so try  to
          avoid  connecting  normally; any necessary connec-
          tion will occur during a queue run.  See also  op-
          tion HoldExpensive.

      E   Escape lines beginning with "From " in the message
          with a `>' sign.

      f   The  mailer wants a -f from flag, but only if this
          is a network forward operation (i.e.,  the  mailer
          will  give an error if the executing user does not
          have special permissions).

      F*  This mailer wants a "From:" header line.

      g   Normally,  sendmail  sends  internally   generated
          email (e.g., error messages) using the null return
          address  as  required  by RFC 1123.  However, some
          mailers don't accept a null  return  address.   If
          necessary, you can set the g flag to prevent send-
          mail  from  obeying  the standards; error messages










SMM:08-92          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


          will be sent as from the MAILER-DAEMON  (actually,
          the value of the $n macro).

      h   Upper  case should be preserved in host names (the
          $@ portion of the  mailer  triplet  resolved  from
          ruleset 0) for this mailer.

      i   Do  User Database rewriting on envelope sender ad-
          dress.

      I   This flag is deprecated and will be removed from a
          future version.  This mailer will be speaking SMTP
          to another sendmail -- as such it can use  special
          protocol  features.   This flag should not be used
          except for debugging purposes because it uses VERB
          as SMTP command.

      j   Do User Database rewriting on recipients  as  well
          as senders.

      k   Normally  when  sendmail  connects  to  a host via
          SMTP, it checks to make sure that this isn't acci-
          dentally the same host name  as  might  happen  if
          sendmail  is  misconfigured or if a long-haul net-
          work interface is set in loopback mode.  This flag
          disables the loopback check.  It  should  only  be
          used under very unusual circumstances.

      K   Currently unimplemented.  Reserved for chunking.

      l   This mailer is local (i.e., final delivery will be
          performed).

      L   Limit  the  line  lengths as specified in RFC 821.
          This deprecated option should be replaced  by  the
          L=  mail declaration.  For historic reasons, the L
          flag also sets the 7 flag.

      m   This mailer can send to multiple users on the same
          host in one transaction.  When a $u  macro  occurs
          in  the  argv  part of the mailer definition, that
          field will be repeated as necessary for all quali-
          fying users.  Removing this flag can defeat dupli-
          cate suppression on a remote site as each  recipi-
          ent is sent in a separate transaction.

      M*  This mailer wants a "Message-Id:" header line.

      n   Do  not  insert  a  UNIX-style  "From" line on the
          front of the message.

      o   Always run as the owner of the recipient  mailbox.
          Normally  sendmail  runs as the sender for locally










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-93


          generated mail or as "daemon" (actually, the  user
          specified in the u option) when delivering network
          mail.  The normal behavior is required by most lo-
          cal  mailers,  which  will  not allow the envelope
          sender address to be set unless the mailer is run-
          ning as daemon.  This flag is  ignored  if  the  S
          flag is set.

      p   Use  the route-addr style reverse-path in the SMTP
          SMTP MAIL command rather than just the return  ad-
          dress;  although  this is required in RFC 821 sec-
          tion 3.1, many hosts do not process  reverse-paths
          properly.   Reverse-paths  are officially discour-
          aged by RFC 1123.

      P*  This mailer wants a "Return-Path:" line.

      q   When an address that resolves to  this  mailer  is
          verified  (SMTP  VRFY  command),  generate 250 re-
          sponses instead of 252 responses.  This will imply
          that the address is local.

      r   Same as f, but sends a -r flag.

      R   Open SMTP connections from a "secure"  port.   Se-
          cure ports aren't (secure, that is) except on UNIX
          machines,  so  it  is  unclear that this adds any-
          thing.  sendmail must be running  as  root  to  be
          able to use this flag.

      s   Strip  quote  characters  (" and \) off of the ad-
          dress before calling the mailer.

      S   Don't reset the userid before calling the  mailer.
          This  would  be used in a secure environment where
          sendmail ran as root.  This could be used to avoid
          forged addresses.  If the U= field is also  speci-
          fied, this flag causes the effective user id to be
          set to that user.

      u   Upper  case  should be preserved in user names for
          this mailer.  Standards  require  preservation  of
          case  in  the  local part of addresses, except for
          those address for which your  system  accepts  re-
          sponsibility.   RFC  2142  provides a long list of
          addresses which should be  case  insensitive.   If
          you  use this flag, you may be violating RFC 2142.
          Note that postmaster is always treated as  a  case
          insensitive address regardless of this flag.

      U   This mailer wants UUCP-style "From" lines with the
          ugly "remote from <host>" on the end.











SMM:08-94          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      w   The  user  must  have  a valid account on this ma-
          chine, i.e., getpwnam must succeed.  If  not,  the
          mail is bounced.  See also the MailboxDatabase op-
          tion.  This is required to get ".forward" capabil-
          ity.

      W   Ignore long term host status information (see Sec-
          tion "Persistent Host Status Information").

      x*  This mailer wants a "Full-Name:" header line.

      X   This  mailer wants to use the hidden dot algorithm
          as specified in RFC 821; basically, any  line  be-
          ginning   with  a  dot  will  have  an  extra  dot
          prepended (to be stripped at the other end).  This
          insures that lines in the message containing a dot
          will not terminate the message prematurely.

      z   Run Local Mail Transfer  Protocol  (LMTP)  between
          sendmail  and the local mailer.  This is a variant
          on SMTP defined in RFC 2033 that  is  specifically
          designed for delivery to a local mailbox.

      Z   Apply DialDelay (if set) to this mailer.

      0   Don't  look  up  MX  records  for  hosts  sent via
          SMTP/LMTP.  Do not apply FallbackMXhost either.

      1   Strip null characters ('\0') when sending to  this
          mailer.

      2   Don't  use  ESMTP  even if offered; this is useful
          for broken systems that offer ESMTP  but  fail  on
          EHLO (without recovering when HELO is tried next).

      3   Extend the list of characters converted to =XX no-
          tation  when converting to Quoted-Printable to in-
          clude those that don't map cleanly  between  ASCII
          and  EBCDIC.  Useful if you have IBM mainframes on
          site.

      5   If no aliases are found for this address, pass the
          address through ruleset 5 for  possible  alternate
          resolution.   This is intended to forward the mail
          to an alternate delivery spot.

      6   Strip headers to seven bits.

      7   Strip all output to seven bits.  This is  the  de-
          fault  if  the  L flag is set.  Note that clearing
          this option is not sufficient to  get  full  eight
          bit data passed through sendmail.  If the 7 option
          is  set, this is essentially always set, since the










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-95


          eighth bit was stripped on input.  Note that  this
          option  will only impact messages that didn't have
          8->7 bit MIME conversions performed.

      8   If set, it is acceptable to send eight bit data to
          this mailer; the usual attempt to do 8->7 bit MIME
          conversions will be bypassed.

      9   If set, do  limited  7->8  bit  MIME  conversions.
          These conversions are limited to text/plain data.

      :   Check  addresses  to  see if they begin with ":in-
          clude:"; if they do, convert  them  to  the  "*in-
          clude*" mailer.

      |   Check  addresses  to see if they begin with a `|';
          if they do, convert them to the "prog" mailer.

      /   Check addresses to see if they begin with  a  `/';
          if they do, convert them to the "*file*" mailer.

      @   Look up addresses in the user database.

      %   Do  not  attempt  delivery on initial receipt of a
          message or on queue runs unless the queued message
          is selected using one of the -qI/-qR/-qS queue run
          modifiers or an ETRN request.

      !   Disable an MH hack that drops  an  explicit  From:
          header  if  it  is the same as what sendmail would
          generate.

           Configuration files prior to level 6  assume  the
      `A',  `w',  `5', `:', `|', `/', and `@' options on the
      mailer named "local".

           The mailer with the special name "error"  can  be
      used  to  generate  a user error.  The (optional) host
      field is an exit status to be returned, and  the  user
      field is a message to be printed.  The exit status may
      be numeric or one of the values USAGE, NOUSER, NOHOST,
      UNAVAILABLE,  SOFTWARE,  TEMPFAIL, PROTOCOL, or CONFIG
      to return the corresponding EX_ exit code, or  an  en-
      hanced  error  code as described in RFC 1893, Enhanced
      Mail System Status Codes.  For example, the entry:

          $#error $@ NOHOST $: Host unknown in this domain

      on the RHS of a rule will cause the specified error to
      be generated and the "Host unknown" exit status to  be
      returned  if  the  LHS  matches.   This mailer is only
      functional in rulesets 0, 5, or  one  of  the  check_*
      rulesets.  The host field can also contain the special










SMM:08-96          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      token  quarantine  which instructs sendmail to quaran-
      tine the current message.

           The mailer with the special name "discard" causes
      any mail sent to it  to  be  discarded  but  otherwise
      treated  as  though  it  were  successfully delivered.
      This mailer cannot be used in ruleset 0, only  in  the
      various address checking rulesets.

           The mailer named "local" must be defined in every
      configuration  file.   This  is  used to deliver local
      mail, and is treated specially in several ways.  Addi-
      tionally, three other mailers named "prog",  "*file*",
      and "*include*" may be defined to tune the delivery of
      messages  to  programs, files, and :include: lists re-
      spectively.  They default to:

          Mprog, P=/bin/sh, F=lsoDq9, T=DNS/RFC822/X-Unix, A=sh -c $u
          M*file*, P=[FILE], F=lsDFMPEouq9, T=DNS/RFC822/X-Unix, A=FILE $u
          M*include*, P=/dev/null, F=su, A=INCLUDE $u


           Builtin pathnames are [FILE] and [IPC], the  for-
      mer  is used for delivery to files, the latter for de-
      livery via interprocess  communication.   For  mailers
      that  use  [IPC]  as pathname the argument vector (A=)
      must start with TCP or FILE for delivery via a TCP  or
      a  Unix domain socket.  If TCP is used, the second ar-
      gument must be the name of the host to  contact.   Op-
      tionally  a  third  argument  can be used to specify a
      port, the default is smtp (port 25).  If FILE is used,
      the second argument must be the name of the  Unix  do-
      main socket.

           If  the  argument vector does not contain $u then
      sendmail will speak SMTP (or LMTP if the mailer flag z
      is specified) to the mailer.

           If no Eol field is defined, then the  default  is
      "\r\n" for SMTP mailers and "\n" of others.

           The  Sender  and Recipient rewriting sets may ei-
      ther be a simple ruleset id or may be  two  ids  sepa-
      rated  by  a  slash; if so, the first rewriting set is
      applied to envelope addresses and the  second  is  ap-
      plied  to headers.  Setting any value to zero disables
      corresponding mailer-specific rewriting.

           The Directory is actually a colon-separated  path
      of  directories  to  try.  For example, the definition
      "D=$z:/" first tries to  execute  in  the  recipient's
      home  directory; if that is not available, it tries to
      execute in  the  root  of  the  filesystem.   This  is










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-97


      intended  to  be used only on the "prog" mailer, since
      some shells (such as csh) refuse to  execute  if  they
      cannot  read  the  current directory.  Since the queue
      directory is not  normally  readable  by  unprivileged
      users csh scripts as recipients can fail.

           The  Userid  specifies the default user and group
      id  to  run  as,  overriding  the  DefaultUser  option
      (q.v.).   If the S mailer flag is also specified, this
      user and group will be set as the  effective  uid  and
      gid  for the process.  This may be given as user:group
      to set both the user and group id; either  may  be  an
      integer  or  a  symbolic  name  to be looked up in the
      passwd and group files respectively.  If only  a  sym-
      bolic  user  name  is  specified,  the group id in the
      passwd file for that user is used as the group id.

           The Charset field is used when converting a  mes-
      sage  to  MIME;  this is the character set used in the
      Content-Type: header.  If this is  not  set,  the  De-
      faultCharSet  option  is used, and if that is not set,
      the value "unknown-8bit" is used.  WARNING: this field
      applies to the sender's mailer,  not  the  recipient's
      mailer.   For  example, if the envelope sender address
      lists an address on the local network and the  recipi-
      ent  is on an external network, the character set will
      be set from the Charset= field for the  local  network
      mailer, not that of the external network mailer.

           The Type= field sets the type information used in
      MIME error messages as defined by RFC 1894.  It is ac-
      tually three values separated by slashes: the MTA-type
      (that is, the description of how hosts are named), the
      address  type  (the  description of e-mail addresses),
      and the diagnostic type (the description of error  di-
      agnostic  codes).   Each of these must be a registered
      value  or   begin   with   "X-".    The   default   is
      "dns/rfc822/smtp".

           The m= field specifies the maximum number of mes-
      sages  to  attempt to deliver on a single SMTP or LMTP
      connection.  The default is infinite.

           The r= field specifies the maximum number of  re-
      cipients  to  attempt to deliver in a single envelope.
      It defaults to 100.

           The /= field specifies a new root  directory  for
      the  mailer.   The  path  is  macro  expanded and then
      passed to the "chroot" system call.  The  root  direc-
      tory  is  changed  before  the Directory field is con-
      sulted or the uid is changed.











SMM:08-98          Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


           The Wait= field specifies  the  maximum  time  to
      wait  for  the mailer to return after sending all data
      to it.  This applies to mailers that have been  forked
      by sendmail.

           The Queuegroup= field specifies the default queue
      group  in  which received mail should be queued.  This
      can be overridden by other means as explained in  sec-
      tion ``Queue Groups and Queue Directories''.

   5.6.  H -- Define Header

           The  format of the header lines that sendmail in-
      serts into the message are defined by the H line.  The
      syntax of this line is one of the following:

          Hhname: htemplate


          H[?mflags?]hname: htemplate


          H[?${macro}?]hname: htemplate

      Continuation lines in this spec are reflected directly
      into the outgoing message.  The htemplate is macro-ex-
      panded before insertion  into  the  message.   If  the
      mflags  (surrounded  by question marks) are specified,
      at least one of the specified flags must be stated  in
      the  mailer definition for this header to be automati-
      cally output.  If a ${macro} (surrounded  by  question
      marks)  is specified, the header will be automatically
      output if the macro is set.  The macro may be set  us-
      ing  any  of  the  normal methods, including using the
      macro storage map in a ruleset.  If one of these head-
      ers is in the input it is reflected to the output  re-
      gardless  of  these  flags  or  macros.   Notice: If a
      ${macro} is used to set a header, then it is useful to
      add that macro  to  class  $={persistentMacros}  which
      consists  of  the  macros  that should be saved across
      queue runs.

           Some headers have special semantics that will  be
      described later.

           A  secondary  syntax allows validation of headers
      as they are being read.  To enable validation, use:

          HHeader: $>Ruleset
          HHeader: $>+Ruleset

      The indicated Ruleset  is  called  for  the  specified
      Header, and can return $#error to reject or quarantine










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide          SMM:08-99


      the  message  or  $#discard to discard the message (as
      with the other check_*  rulesets).   The  ruleset  re-
      ceives  the  header  field-body as argument, i.e., not
      the header field-name; see also ${hdr_name} and ${cur-
      rHeader}.  The  header  is  treated  as  a  structured
      field,  that is, text in parentheses is deleted before
      processing, unless the second form $>+ is used.  Note:
      only one ruleset can  be  associated  with  a  header;
      sendmail will silently ignore multiple entries.

           For example, the configuration lines:

          HMessage-Id: $>CheckMessageId

          SCheckMessageId
          R< $+ @ $+  >$@ OK
          R$*       $#error $: Illegal Message-Id header

      would refuse any message that had a Message-Id: header
      of any of the following forms:

          Message-Id: <>
          Message-Id: some text
          Message-Id: <legal text@domain> extra crud

      A  default  ruleset  that  is called for headers which
      don't have a specific ruleset defined for them can  be
      specified by:

          H*: $>Ruleset

      or

          H*: $>+Ruleset


   5.7.  O -- Set Option

           There  are a number of global options that can be
      set from a configuration  file.   Options  are  repre-
      sented  by  full words; some are also representable as
      single characters for back compatibility.  The  syntax
      of this line is:

          O  option=value

      This  sets option option to be value.  Note that there
      must be a space between the letter `O' and the name of
      the option.  An older version is:

          Oovalue

      where the option o is a single  character.   Depending










SMM:08-100         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      on  the  option,  value may be a string, an integer, a
      boolean (with legal values "t", "T", "f", or "F";  the
      default is TRUE), or a time interval.

           All  filenames used in options should be absolute
      paths, i.e., starting with  '/'.   Relative  filenames
      most  likely  cause surprises during operation (unless
      otherwise noted).

           The options supported (with the old, one  charac-
      ter names in brackets) are:

      AliasFile=spec, spec, ...
                [A]  Specify  possible  alias file(s).  Each
                spec should be in the format ``class: info''
                where class: is  optional  and  defaults  to
                ``implicit''.   Note  that  info is required
                for all  classes  except  "ldap".   For  the
                "ldap"  class,  if  info is not specified, a
                default info value is used as follows:

                    -k (&(objectClass=sendmailMTAAliasObject)
                         (sendmailMTAAliasName=aliases)
                         (|(sendmailMTACluster=${sendmailMTACluster})
                           (sendmailMTAHost=$j))
                         (sendmailMTAKey=%0))
                    -v sendmailMTAAliasValue

                Depending on how sendmail is compiled, valid
                classes are  "implicit"  (search  through  a
                compiled-in  list  of  alias file types, for
                back compatibility),  "hash"  (if  NEWDB  is
                specified), "btree" (if NEWDB is specified),
                "dbm"  (if NDBM is specified), "cdb" (if CDB
                is specified), "stab" (internal symbol table
                -- not normally  used  unless  you  have  no
                other  database  lookup),  "sequence" (use a
                sequence  of  maps   previously   declared),
                "ldap"  (if  LDAPMAP is specified), or "nis"
                (if NIS is specified).  If a list  of  specs
                are  provided, sendmail searches them in or-
                der.

      AliasWait=timeout
                [a] If set, wait up to  timeout  (units  de-
                fault  to minutes) for an "@:@" entry to ex-
                ist in the alias  database  before  starting
                up.   If  it  does not appear in the timeout
                interval issue a warning.

      AllowBogusHELO
                If set, allow HELO SMTP commands that  don't
                include  a host name.  Setting this violates










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-101


                RFC 1123 section 5.2.5, but is necessary  to
                interoperate  with several SMTP clients.  If
                there is a value, it is  still  checked  for
                legitimacy.

      AuthMaxBits=N
                Limit  the  maximum  encryption strength for
                the security layer in SMTP AUTH (SASL).  De-
                fault is essentially unlimited.  This allows
                to turn off additional encryption in SASL if
                STARTTLS  is already encrypting the communi-
                cation,  because  the  existing   encryption
                strength is taken into account when choosing
                an  algorithm  for  the security layer.  For
                example, if STARTTLS is used and the symmet-
                ric cipher is 3DES, then the  keylength  (in
                bits)  is 168.  Hence setting AuthMaxBits to
                168 will disable any encryption in SASL.

      AuthMechanisms
                List of authentication mechanisms  for  AUTH
                (separated  by spaces).  The advertised list
                of authentication mechanisms will be the in-
                tersection of this  list  and  the  list  of
                available  mechanisms  as  determined by the
                Cyrus SASL library.  If STARTTLS is  active,
                EXTERNAL  will  be  added  to this list.  In
                that case, the value  of  {cert_subject}  is
                used as authentication id.

      AuthOptions
                List  of options for SMTP AUTH consisting of
                single  characters  with  intervening  white
                space or commas.





























SMM:08-102         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                    A   Use the AUTH= parameter for the MAIL
                        command only when authentication succeeded.
                        This can be used as a workaround for broken
                        MTAs that do not implement RFC 2554 correctly.
                    a   protection from active (non-dictionary) attacks
                        during authentication exchange.
                    c   require mechanisms which pass client credentials,
                        and allow mechanisms which can pass credentials
                        to do so.
                    d   don't permit mechanisms susceptible to passive
                        dictionary attack.
                    f   require forward secrecy between sessions
                        (breaking one won't help break next).
                    m   require mechanisms which provide mutual authentication
                        (only available if using Cyrus SASL v2 or later).
                    p   don't permit mechanisms susceptible to simple
                        passive attack (e.g., PLAIN, LOGIN), unless a
                        security layer is active.
                    y   don't permit mechanisms that allow anonymous login.

                The  first  option  applies to sendmail as a
                client, the others to a server.  Example:

                    O AuthOptions=p,y

                would disallow ANONYMOUS as  AUTH  mechanism
                and  would  allow  PLAIN and LOGIN only if a
                security layer (e.g., provided by  STARTTLS)
                is  already  active.   The options 'a', 'c',
                'd', 'f', 'p', and 'y' refer  to  properties
                of  the  selected SASL mechanisms.  Explana-
                tions of these properties can  be  found  in
                the Cyrus SASL documentation.

      AuthRealm The  authentication  realm that is passed to
                the Cyrus SASL  library.   If  no  realm  is
                specified, $j is used.  See also KNOWNBUGS.

      BadRcptThrottle=N
                If  set  and the specified number of recipi-
                ents in a single SMTP transaction have  been
                rejected,  sleep  for  one second after each
                subsequent RCPT command in that transaction.

      BlankSub=c
                [B] Set the blank substitution character  to
                c.   Unquoted  spaces  in  addresses are re-
                placed by this character.  Defaults to space
                (i.e., no change is made).

      CACertPath
                Path to directory with certificates of  CAs.
                This  directory  directory  must contain the










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-103


                hashes of each CA certificate  as  filenames
                (or as links to them).

      CACertFile
                File containing one or more CA certificates;
                see section about STARTTLS for more informa-
                tion.

      CertFingerprintAlgorithm
                Specify  the  fingerprint algorithm (digest)
                to use for the presented cert.  If  the  op-
                tion  is  not set, md5 is used and the macro
                ${cert_md5} contains the  cert  fingerprint.
                If  the option is explicitly set, the speci-
                fied algorithm (e.g., sha1) is used and  the
                macro  ${cert_fp}  contains the cert finger-
                print.

      CipherList
                Specify cipher list for STARTTLS  (does  not
                apply  to TLSv1.3).  See ciphers(1) for pos-
                sible values.

      CheckAliases
                [n] Validate the RHS  of  aliases  when  re-
                building the alias database.

      CheckpointInterval=N
                [C]  Checkpoints  the queue every N (default
                10) addresses sent.  If your system  crashes
                during  delivery  to a large list, this pre-
                vents retransmission to any but the  last  N
                recipients.

      ClassFactor=fact
                [z]  The  indicated  factor is multiplied by
                the message class (determined by the  Prece-
                dence:  field  in  the user header and the P
                lines in the configuration  file)  and  sub-
                tracted  from  the priority.  Thus, messages
                with a higher  Priority:  will  be  favored.
                Defaults to 1800.

      ClientCertFile
                File   containing  the  certificate  of  the
                client, i.e., this certificate is used  when
                sendmail acts as client (for STARTTLS).

      ClientKeyFile
                File containing the private key belonging to
                the  client  certificate  (for  STARTTLS  if
                sendmail runs as client).











SMM:08-104         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      ClientPortOptions=options
                Set client SMTP options.   The  options  are
                key=value  pairs separated by commas.  Known
                keys are:

                    Port      Name/number of source port for connection (defaults to any free port)
                    Addr      Address mask (defaults INADDR_ANY)
                    Family    Address family (defaults to INET)
                    SndBufSizeSize of TCP send buffer
                    RcvBufSizeSize of TCP receive buffer
                    Modifier  Options (flags) for the client

                The Address mask may be a numeric address in
                IPv4 dot notation or IPv6 colon notation  or
                a network name.  Note that if a network name
                is  specified, only the first IP address re-
                turned for it will be used.  This may  cause
                indeterminate  behavior  for  network  names
                that resolve to multiple addresses.   There-
                fore,  use  of  an  address  is recommended.
                Modifier can be the following character:

                    h         use name of interface for HELO command
                    A         don't use AUTH when sending e-mail
                    S         don't use STARTTLS when sending e-mail

                If ``h'' is set, the name  corresponding  to
                the outgoing interface address (whether cho-
                sen  via the Connection parameter or the de-
                fault) is used for  the  HELO/EHLO  command.
                However,  the  name  must  not  start with a
                square bracket and it must contain at  least
                one  dot.  This is a simple test whether the
                name is not an IP address (in square  brack-
                ets)  but  a  qualified hostname.  Note that
                multiple ClientPortOptions settings are  al-
                lowed  in  order  to  give settings for each
                protocol family (e.g., one  for  Family=inet
                and  one  for  Family=inet6).  A restriction
                placed on one family only  affects  outgoing
                connections on that particular family.

      ClientSSLOptions
                A  space  or comma separated list of SSL re-
                lated options  for  the  client  side.   See
                SSL_CTX_set_options(3)   for   a  list;  the
                available values depend on the OpenSSL  ver-
                sion against which sendmail is compiled.  By
                default,      SSL_OP_ALL     SSL_OP_NO_SSLv2
                SSL_OP_NO_TICKET -SSL_OP_TLSEXT_PADDING  are
                used  (if those options are available).  Op-
                tions can be cleared by preceding them  with
                a  minus  sign.   It  is  also  possible  to










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-105


                specify numerical values, e.g., -0x0010.

      ColonOkInAddr
                If set, colons are acceptable in e-mail  ad-
                dresses  (e.g.,  "host:user").   If not set,
                colons indicate the beginning of a  RFC  822
                group  construct  ("groupname: member1, mem-
                ber2, ... memberN;").   Doubled  colons  are
                always   acceptable  ("nodename::user")  and
                proper  route-addr  nesting  is   understood
                ("<@relay:user@host>").   Furthermore,  this
                option defaults on if the configuration ver-
                sion level is less than 6 (for back compati-
                bility).  However, it must be off  for  full
                compatibility with RFC 822.

      ConnectionCacheSize=N
                [k]  The  maximum number of open connections
                that will be cached at a time.  The  default
                is  one.   This  delays  closing the current
                connection until either this  invocation  of
                sendmail needs to connect to another host or
                it  terminates.  Setting it to zero defaults
                to the old behavior,  that  is,  connections
                are closed immediately.  Since this consumes
                file   descriptors,   the  connection  cache
                should be kept small: 4 is probably a  prac-
                tical maximum.

      ConnectionCacheTimeout=timeout
                [K] The maximum amount of time a cached con-
                nection  will  be  permitted to idle without
                activity.  If this  time  is  exceeded,  the
                connection   is  immediately  closed.   This
                value should be small (on the order  of  ten
                minutes).   Before  sendmail  uses  a cached
                connection, it always sends a  RSET  command
                to  check  the connection; if this fails, it
                reopens the connection.  This keeps your end
                from failing if the  other  end  times  out.
                The  point  of  this  option is to be a good
                network neighbor and avoid using  up  exces-
                sive  resources  on  the other end.  The de-
                fault is five minutes.

      ConnectOnlyTo=address
                This can be used to override the  connection
                address (for testing purposes).

      ConnectionRateThrottle=N
                If  set  to  a positive value, allow no more
                than N incoming connections in a one  second
                period  per  daemon.   This  is  intended to










SMM:08-106         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                flatten out peaks and allow the load average
                checking to cut in.  Defaults  to  zero  (no
                limits).

      ConnectionRateWindowSize=N
                Define  the length of the interval for which
                the number of incoming connections is  main-
                tained.  The default is 60 seconds.

      ControlSocketName=name
                Name  of  the control socket for daemon man-
                agement.  A running sendmail daemon  can  be
                controlled   through   this   named  socket.
                Available   commands   are:   help,   mstat,
                restart,  shutdown,  and status.  The status
                command returns the current number of daemon
                children, the maximum number of daemon chil-
                dren, the free disk space (in blocks) of the
                queue directory, and the load average of the
                machine expressed as  an  integer.   If  not
                set,  no  control  socket will be available.
                Solaris and pre-4.4BSD kernel  users  should
                see the note in sendmail/README .

      CRLFile=name
                Name of file that contains certificate revo-
                cation  status, useful for X.509v3 authenti-
                cation.  Note: if a CRLFile is specified but
                the file is unusable, STARTTLS is disabled.

      CRLPath=name
                Name  of  directory  that  contains   hashes
                pointing  to  certificate  revocation status
                files.  Symbolic links can be generated with
                the following two (Bourne) shell commands:

                    C=FileName_of_CRL
                    ln -s $C `openssl crl -noout -hash < $C`.r0


      DHParameters
                This option applies to the server side only.
                Possible values are:

                    5                   use precomputed 512 bit prime.
                    1                   generate 1024 bit prime
                    2                   generate 2048 bit prime.
                    i                   use included precomputed 2048 bit prime (default).
                    none                do not use Diffie-Hellman.
                    /path/to/file       load prime from file.

                This is only required if a ciphersuite  con-
                taining  DSA/DH  is  used.   The  default is










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-107


                ``i'' which  selects  a  precomputed,  fixed
                2048  bit prime.  If ``5'' is selected, then
                precomputed, fixed primes are  used.   Note:
                this  option should not be used (unless nec-
                essary for compatibility with old  implemen-
                tations).   If  ``1''  or ``2'' is selected,
                then  prime  values  are   computed   during
                startup.   Note:  this  operation can take a
                significant amount of time on a slow machine
                (several seconds), but it is only done  once
                at  startup.   If ``none'' is selected, then
                TLS ciphersuites containing DSA/DH cannot be
                used.  If a file name  is  specified  (which
                must  be  an absolute path), then the primes
                are read from it.  It is recommended to gen-
                erate such a file using a command like this:

                                        openssl dhparam -out /etc/mail/dhparams.pem 2048

                If the file is not readable or contains  un-
                usable  data,  the default ``i'' is used in-
                stead.

      DaemonPortOptions=options
                [O] Set server SMTP options.  Each  instance
                of  DaemonPortOptions leads to an additional
                incoming socket.  The options are  key=value
                pairs.  Known keys are:

                    Name      User-definable name for the daemon (defaults to "Daemon#")
                    Port      Name/number of listening port (defaults to "smtp")
                    Addr      Address mask (defaults INADDR_ANY)
                    Family    Address family (defaults to INET)
                    InputMailFiltersList of input mail filters for the daemon
                    Listen    Size of listen queue (defaults to 10)
                    Modifier  Options (flags) for the daemon
                    SndBufSizeSize of TCP send buffer
                    RcvBufSizeSize of TCP receive buffer
                    children  maximum number of children per daemon, see MaxDaemonChildren.
                    DeliveryModeDelivery mode per daemon, see DeliveryMode.
                    refuseLA  RefuseLA per daemon
                    delayLA   DelayLA per daemon
                    queueLA   QueueLA per daemon

                The  Name key is used for error messages and
                logging.  The Address mask may be a  numeric
                address  in  IPv4 dot notation or IPv6 colon
                notation, or a network name, or a path to  a
                local  socket.   Note that if a network name
                is specified, only the first IP address  re-
                turned  for it will be used.  This may cause
                indeterminate  behavior  for  network  names
                that    resolve   to   multiple   addresses.










SMM:08-108         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                Therefore, use of an address is recommended.
                The Family  key  defaults  to  INET  (IPv4).
                IPv6 users who wish to also accept IPv6 con-
                nections  should add additional Family=inet6
                DaemonPortOptions  lines.    For   a   local
                socket,  use  Family=local  or  Family=unix.
                The InputMailFilters key overrides  the  de-
                fault  list  of input mail filters listed in
                the InputMailFilters  option.   If  multiple
                input  mail  filters are required, they must
                be separated  by  semicolons  (not  commas).
                Modifier  can be a sequence (without any de-
                limiters) of the following characters:

                    a         always require AUTH
                    b         bind to interface through which mail has been received
                    c         perform hostname canonification (.cf)
                    f         require fully qualified hostname (.cf)
                    s         Run smtps (SMTP over SSL) instead of smtp
                    u         allow unqualified addresses (.cf)
                    A         disable AUTH (overrides 'a' modifier)
                    C         don't perform hostname canonification
                    E         disallow ETRN (see RFC 2476)
                    O         optional; if opening the socket fails ignore it
                    S         don't offer STARTTLS

                That is, one way to specify a  message  sub-
                mission  agent  (MSA)  that  always requires
                AUTH is:

                    O DaemonPortOptions=Name=MSA, Port=587, M=Ea

                The modifiers that are marked  with  "(.cf)"
                have  only effect in the standard configura-
                tion file, in which they are  available  via
                ${daemon_flags}.   Notice:  Do  not  use the
                ``a'' modifier on a public  accessible  MTA!
                It should only be used for a MSA that is ac-
                cessed  by authorized users for initial mail
                submission.  Users must authenticate to  use
                a  MSA which has this option turned on.  The
                flags ``c'' and ``C'' can change the default
                for hostname  canonification  in  the  send-
                mail.cf  file.   See the relevant documenta-
                tion for FEATURE(nocanonify).  The  modifier
                ``f''   disallows   addresses  of  the  form
                user@host  unless  they  are  submitted  di-
                rectly.   The  flag ``u'' allows unqualified
                sender addresses, i.e., those without @host.
                ``b'' forces sendmail to bind to the  inter-
                face  through  which the e-mail has been re-
                ceived for the outgoing  connection.   WARN-
                ING:  Use ``b'' only if outgoing mail can be










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-109


                routed through the incoming connection's in-
                terface to its destination.  No  attempt  is
                made  to catch problems due to a misconfigu-
                ration of this parameter, use  it  only  for
                virtual hosting where each virtual interface
                can  connect  to  every  possible  location.
                This will also  override  possible  settings
                via  ClientPortOptions.  Note, sendmail will
                listen on a new socket for  each  occurrence
                of the DaemonPortOptions option in a config-
                uration  file.   The  modifier  ``O'' causes
                sendmail to ignore a socket if it  can't  be
                opened.   This  applies to failures from the
                socket(2) and bind(2) calls.

      DefaultAuthInfo
                Filename that contains  default  authentica-
                tion  information  for outgoing connections.
                This file must contain the user id, the  au-
                thorization  id,  the password (plain text),
                the realm and the list of mechanisms to  use
                on  separate  lines  and must be readable by
                root (or the  trusted  user)  only.   If  no
                realm is specified, $j is used.  If no mech-
                anisms  are specified, the list given by Au-
                thMechanisms is used.  Notice:  this  option
                is  deprecated and will be removed in future
                versions.  Moreover, it doesn't work for the
                MSP since it can't read the file  (the  file
                must  not  be group/world-readable otherwise
                sendmail will complain).  Use  the  authinfo
                ruleset  instead which provides more control
                over the usage of the data anyway.

      DefaultCharSet=charset
                When a message that has 8-bit characters but
                is not in MIME format is converted  to  MIME
                (see  the  EightBitMode  option) a character
                set must be included  in  the  Content-Type:
                header.   This character set is normally set
                from the Charset= field of  the  mailer  de-
                scriptor.   If that is not set, the value of
                this option is used.  If this option is  not
                set, the value "unknown-8bit" is used.

      DataFileBufferSize=threshold
                Set  the  threshold, in bytes, before a mem-
                ory-based  queue  data  file  becomes  disk-
                based.  The default is 4096 bytes.

      DeadLetterDrop=file
                Defines  the  location  of  the  system-wide
                dead.letter  file,  formerly  hardcoded   to










SMM:08-110         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                /usr/tmp/dead.letter.  If this option is not
                set (the default), sendmail will not attempt
                to save to a system-wide dead.letter file in
                the  event  it cannot bounce the mail to the
                user or postmaster.  Instead, it will rename
                the qf file as it has in the past  when  the
                dead.letter file could not be opened.

      DefaultUser=user:group
                [u]  Set  the  default userid for mailers to
                user:group.  If group is omitted and user is
                a user name (as opposed to  a  numeric  user
                id)   the   default   group  listed  in  the
                /etc/passwd file for that user  is  used  as
                the  default group.  Both user and group may
                be numeric.  Mailers without the S  flag  in
                the mailer definition will run as this user.
                Defaults  to  1:1.   The  value  can also be
                given as a symbolic user name.[19]

      DelayLA=LA
                When  the  system  load  average exceeds LA,
                sendmail will sleep for one second  on  most
                SMTP  commands  and before accepting connec-
                tions.

      DeliverByMin=time
                Set minimum time for Deliver By SMTP Service
                Extension (RFC 2852).   If  0,  no  time  is
                listed, if less than 0, the extension is not
                offered,  if greater than 0, it is listed as
                minimum time for the EHLO keyword DELIVERBY.

      DeliveryMode=x
                [d] Deliver in mode x.  Legal modes are:

                    i   Deliver interactively (synchronously)
                    b   Deliver in background (asynchronously)
                    q   Just queue the message (deliver during queue run)
                    d   Defer delivery and all map lookups (deliver during queue run)

                Defaults to ``b'' if no option is specified,
                ``i'' if it is specified but given no  argu-
                ment   (i.e.,   ``Od''   is   equivalent  to
                ``Odi'').  The -v  command  line  flag  sets
                this  to  i.   Note:  for  internal reasons,
                ``i'' does not work if a milter  is  enabled
                which  can  reject or delete recipients.  In
____________________
   [19]The old g option has been combined into the  Default-
User option.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-111


                that case the mode will be changed to ``b''.

      DialDelay=sleeptime
                Dial-on-demand network connections  can  see
                timeouts  if  a  connection is opened before
                the call is set up.  If this is  set  to  an
                interval  and  a connection times out on the
                first connection  being  attempted  sendmail
                will  sleep  for this amount of time and try
                again.  This should give your system time to
                establish the  connection  to  your  service
                provider.  Units default to seconds, so "Di-
                alDelay=5"  uses  a  five second delay.  De-
                faults to zero (no retry).  This delay  only
                applies  to  mailers  which  have the Z flag
                set.

      DirectSubmissionModifiers=modifiers
                Defines ${daemon_flags} for direct  (command
                line)   submissions.   If  not  set,  ${dae-
                mon_flags} is either "CC f" if the option -G
                is used or "c u" otherwise.  Note that  only
                the  "CC",  "c",  "f",  and  "u"  flags  are
                checked.

      DontBlameSendmail=option,option,...
                In order to avoid possible cracking attempts
                caused by world-  and  group-writable  files
                and   directories,  sendmail  does  paranoid
                checking when opening most  of  its  support
                files.   If  for  some reason you absolutely
                must run with, for example, a group-writable
                /etc directory, then you will have  to  turn
                off  this  checking  (at  the cost of making
                your system more vulnerable to attack).  The
                possible arguments have been described  ear-
                lier.   The  details  of these flags are de-
                scribed above.  Use of this  option  is  not
                recommended.

      DontExpandCnames
                The  standards  say  that all host addresses
                used in a mail message must be fully canoni-
                cal.  For example, if  your  host  is  named
                "Cruft.Foo.ORG"  and  also  has  an alias of
                "FTP.Foo.ORG", the former name must be  used
                at  all times.  This is enforced during host
                name canonification ($[ ... $] lookups).  If
                this option is set, the  protocols  are  ig-
                nored  and  the "wrong" thing is done.  How-
                ever, the IETF  is  moving  toward  changing
                this  standard,  so  the behavior may become
                acceptable.    Please   note   that    hosts










SMM:08-112         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                downstream  may still rewrite the address to
                be the true canonical name however.

      DontInitGroups
                If set, sendmail will avoid using the  init-
                groups(3)  call.   If  you  are running NIS,
                this  causes  a  sequential  scan   of   the
                groups.byname  map, which can cause your NIS
                server to be badly overloaded in a large do-
                main.  The cost of this  is  that  the  only
                group  found for users will be their primary
                group (the one in the password file),  which
                will  make  file access permissions somewhat
                more restrictive.  Has no effect on  systems
                that don't have group lists.

      DontProbeInterfaces
                Sendmail normally finds the names of all in-
                terfaces  active  on  your  machine  when it
                starts up and adds their  name  to  the  $=w
                class  of known host aliases.  If you have a
                large number of  virtual  interfaces  or  if
                your  DNS  inverse lookups are slow this can
                be time consuming.  This  option  turns  off
                that  probing.  However, you will need to be
                certain to include all variant names in  the
                $=w  class  by some other mechanism.  If set
                to loopback, loopback interfaces (e.g., lo0)
                will not be probed.

      DontPruneRoutes
                [R] Normally, sendmail  tries  to  eliminate
                any unnecessary explicit routes when sending
                an error message (as discussed in RFC 1123 S
                5.2.6).   For example, when sending an error
                message to

                    <@known1,@known2,@known3:user@unknown>

                sendmail     will     strip     off      the
                "@known1,@known2" in order to make the route
                as  direct  as  possible.  However, if the R
                option is set, this will  be  disabled,  and
                the  mail  will be sent to the first address
                in the route, even if  later  addresses  are
                known.  This may be useful if you are caught
                behind a firewall.

      DoubleBounceAddress=error-address
                If  an  error  occurs  when sending an error
                message, send the  error  report  (termed  a
                "double  bounce"  because  it  is  an  error
                "bounce" that occurs  when  trying  to  send










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-113


                another error "bounce") to the indicated ad-
                dress.  The address is macro expanded at the
                time  of  delivery.  If not set, defaults to
                "postmaster".  If set to  an  empty  string,
                double bounces are dropped.

      EightBitMode=action
                [8]  Set  handling of eight-bit data.  There
                are two kinds of eight-bit  data:  that  de-
                clared as such using the BODY=8BITMIME ESMTP
                declaration  or  the -B8BITMIME command line
                flag, and undeclared 8-bit  data,  that  is,
                input  that  just  happens to be eight bits.
                There are three basic  operations  that  can
                happen:  undeclared  8-bit data can be auto-
                matically converted to 8BITMIME,  undeclared
                8-bit  data can be passed as-is without con-
                version to MIME (``just send 8''),  and  de-
                clared 8-bit data can be converted to 7-bits
                for  transmission  to a non-8BITMIME mailer.
                The possible actions are:

                      s Reject undeclared 8-bit data (``strict'')
                      m Convert undeclared 8-bit data to MIME (``mime'')
                      p Pass undeclared 8-bit data (``pass'')

                In all cases properly declared 8BITMIME data
                will be converted to 7BIT as needed.   Note:
                if  an  automatic conversion is performed, a
                header with the  following  format  will  be
                added:

                    X-MIME-Autoconverted: from OLD to NEW by $j id $i

                where OLD and NEW describe the original for-
                mat and the converted format, respectively.

      ErrorHeader=file-or-message
                [E]  Prepend  error  messages with the indi-
                cated message.  If it begins with  a  slash,
                it  is  assumed to be the pathname of a file
                containing a message  (this  is  the  recom-
                mended setting).  Otherwise, it is a literal
                message.   The  error file might contain the
                name, email address, and/or phone number  of
                a  local postmaster who could provide assis-
                tance to end users.  If the option is  miss-
                ing  or  null,  or  if it names a file which
                does not exist or which is not readable,  no
                message is printed.

      ErrorMode=x
                [e]  Dispose  of  errors  using mode x.  The










SMM:08-114         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                values for x are:

                    p   Print error messages (default)
                    q   No messages, just give exit status
                    m   Mail back errors
                    w   Write back errors (mail if user not logged in)
                    e   Mail back errors (when applicable) and give zero exit stat always

                Note that the last mode, "e", is for Berknet
                error processing and should not be  used  in
                normal  circumstances.  Note, too, that mode
                "q", only applies to errors  recognized  be-
                fore sendmail forks for background delivery.

      FallbackMXhost=fallbackhost
                [V] If specified, the fallbackhost acts like
                a  very  low  priority  MX  on  a  host.  MX
                records will be looked up for this host, un-
                less the name is surrounded by square brack-
                ets.  This is intended to be used  by  sites
                with  poor  network  connectivity.  Messages
                which are undeliverable due to temporary ad-
                dress failures (e.g., DNS failure)  also  go
                to the FallbackMXhost.

      FallBackSmartHost=hostname
                If  specified, the FallBackSmartHost will be
                used in a  last-ditch  effort  for  a  host.
                This  is  intended  to be used by sites with
                "fake internal DNS", e.g., a  company  whose
                DNS  accurately  reflects  the  world inside
                that company's domain but not outside.

      FastSplit If set to a value greater than zero (the de-
                fault is one), it suppresses the MX  lookups
                on addresses when they are initially sorted,
                i.e.,  for the first delivery attempt.  This
                usually results in faster envelope splitting
                unless the MX records are readily  available
                in  a  local  DNS cache.  To enforce initial
                sorting based on MX records set FastSplit to
                zero.  If the  mail  is  submitted  directly
                from  the  command line, then the value also
                limits the number of  processes  to  deliver
                the envelopes; if more envelopes are created
                they  are  only  queued up and must be taken
                care of by a queue run.  Since  the  default
                submission method is via SMTP (either from a
                MUA  or via the MSP), the value of FastSplit
                is  seldom  used  to  limit  the  number  of
                processes to deliver the envelopes.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-115


      ForkEachJob
                [Y]  If  set,  deliver  each job that is run
                from the queue in a separate process.

      ForwardPath=path
                [J] Set the path for  searching  for  users'
                .forward  files.   The  default is "$z/.for-
                ward".  Some sites that use the  automounter
                may  prefer  to  change  this  to "/var/for-
                ward/$u" to search a file with the same name
                as the user in a system directory.   It  can
                also be set to a sequence of paths separated
                by  colons; sendmail stops at the first file
                it can successfully and  safely  open.   For
                example,  "/var/forward/$u:$z/.forward" will
                search first  in  /var/forward/username  and
                then  in ~username/.forward (but only if the
                first file does not exist).

      HeloName=name
                Set the name to be used for  HELO/EHLO  (in-
                stead of $j).

      HelpFile=file
                [H]  Specify  the help file for SMTP.  If no
                file name is specified, "helpfile" is  used.
                If  the  help file does not exist (cannot be
                opened for reading) sendmail  will  print  a
                note  including its version in response to a
                HELP command.  To avoid providing  this  in-
                formation to a client specify an empty file.

      HoldExpensive
                [c] If an outgoing mailer is marked as being
                expensive, don't connect immediately.

      HostsFile=path
                The  path  to  the  hosts database, normally
                "/etc/hosts".  This option is only consulted
                when sendmail is canonifying addresses,  and
                then  only  when  "files"  is in the "hosts"
                service switch entry.  In  particular,  this
                file  is never used when looking up host ad-
                dresses; that is under the  control  of  the
                system gethostbyname(3) routine.

      HostStatusDirectory=path
                The  location  of  the long term host status
                information.  When  set,  information  about
                the  status of hosts (e.g., host down or not
                accepting connections) will  be  shared  be-
                tween all sendmail processes; normally, this
                information  is  only  held  within a single










SMM:08-116         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                queue run.  This option requires  a  connec-
                tion  cache  of  at least 1 to function.  If
                the option begins with a leading `/', it  is
                an absolute pathname; otherwise, it is rela-
                tive  to  the  mail queue directory.  A sug-
                gested value for sites  desiring  persistent
                host  status  is ".hoststat" (i.e., a subdi-
                rectory of the queue directory).

      IgnoreDots
                [i] Do not treat leading  dots  in  incoming
                messages in a special way, e.g., as end of a
                message  if  it  is  the only character in a
                line.  This is always disabled when  reading
                SMTP mail.

      InputMailFilters=name,name,...
                A  comma separated list of filters which de-
                termines which filters (see the "X  --  Mail
                Filter  (Milter)  Definitions"  section) and
                the invocation sequence  are  contacted  for
                incoming SMTP messages.  If none are set, no
                filters will be contacted.

      LDAPDefaultSpec=spec
                Sets  a  default  map specification for LDAP
                maps.  The value should  only  contain  LDAP
                specific  settings  such as "-h host -p port
                -d bindDN".  The settings will be  used  for
                all  LDAP  maps  unless  the  individual map
                specification overrides a setting.  This op-
                tion should be set before any LDAP maps  are
                defined.

      LogLevel=n
                [L] Set the log level to n.  Defaults to 9.

      Mxvalue   [no  long version] Set the macro x to value.
                This is intended only for use from the  com-
                mand line.  The -M flag is preferred.

      MailboxDatabase
                Type of lookup to find information about lo-
                cal mailboxes, defaults to ``pw'' which uses
                getpwnam.   Other types can be introduced by
                adding  them  to  the   source   code,   see
                libsm/mbdb.c for details.

      UseMSP    Use  as mail submission program, i.e., allow
                group writable queue files if the  group  is
                the  same as that of a set-group-ID sendmail
                binary.  See the file  sendmail/SECURITY  in
                the distribution tarball.










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-117


      MatchGECOS
                [G] Allow fuzzy matching on the GECOS field.
                If this flag is set, and the usual user name
                lookups  fail  (that  is,  there is no alias
                with this name and a  getpwnam  fails),  se-
                quentially  search  the  password file for a
                matching entry in  the  GECOS  field.   This
                also  requires  that MATCHGECOS be turned on
                during compilation.  This option is not rec-
                ommended.

      MaxAliasRecursion=N
                The maximum depth of  alias  recursion  (de-
                fault: 10).

      MaxDaemonChildren=N
                If  set,  sendmail  will  refuse connections
                when it has more than N children  processing
                incoming mail or automatic queue runs.  This
                does  not  limit the number of outgoing con-
                nections.   If  the   default   DeliveryMode
                (background) is used, then sendmail may cre-
                ate  an  almost unlimited number of children
                (depending on the number of transactions and
                the relative execution times of mail receip-
                tion  and  mail  delivery).   If  the  limit
                should  be  enforced,  then  a  DeliveryMode
                other than background must be used.  If  not
                set,  there  is  no  limit  to the number of
                children -- that is, the system load average
                controls this.

      MaxHeadersLength=N
                If set to a value greater than zero it spec-
                ifies the maximum length of the sum  of  all
                headers.   This can be used to prevent a de-
                nial of service attack.  The default is 32K.

      MaxHopCount=N
                [h] The maximum hop  count.   Messages  that
                have  been  processed  more than N times are
                assumed to be in a loop  and  are  rejected.
                Defaults to 25.

      MaxMessageSize=N
                Specify  the  maximum message size to be ad-
                vertised in the ESMTP EHLO  response.   Mes-
                sages larger than this will be rejected.  If
                set to a value greater than zero, that value
                will  be listed in the SIZE response, other-
                wise SIZE is advertised in  the  ESMTP  EHLO
                response without a parameter.











SMM:08-118         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      MaxMimeHeaderLength=N[/M]
                Sets  the  maximum  length  of  certain MIME
                header field values to N characters.   These
                MIME header fields are determined by being a
                member   of   class  {checkMIMETextHeaders},
                which currently  contains  only  the  header
                Content-Description.    For  some  of  these
                headers which take parameters,  the  maximum
                length  of  each  parameter  is  set to M if
                specified.  If /M is not specified, one half
                of N will be used.  By default, these values
                are 2048 and 1024, respectively.   To  allow
                any length, a value of 0 can be specified.

      MaxNOOPCommands=N
                Override  the default of MAXNOOPCOMMANDS for
                the number of useless commands, see  Section
                "Measures  against  Denial  of  Service  At-
                tacks".

      MaxQueueChildren=N
                When set, this limits the number of  concur-
                rent  queue  runner  processes  to  N.  This
                helps to control the amount  of  system  re-
                sources  used  when  processing  the  queue.
                When there are multiple queue groups defined
                and the total number of  queue  runners  for
                these   queue   groups   would  exceed  Max-
                QueueChildren then the queue groups will not
                all run concurrently. That is, some  portion
                of  the  queue  groups will run concurrently
                such that MaxQueueChildren will not  be  ex-
                ceeded,  while  the  remaining  queue groups
                will be run later (in  round  robin  order).
                See  also MaxRunnersPerQueue and the section
                Queue Group Declaration.   Notice:  sendmail
                does not count individual queue runners, but
                only  sets  of processes that act on a work-
                group.  Hence the  actual  number  of  queue
                runners  may be lower than the limit imposed
                by MaxQueueChildren.  This  discrepancy  can
                be  large if some queue runners have to wait
                for a slow server and if short intervals are
                used.

      MaxQueueRunSize=N
                The maximum number  of  jobs  that  will  be
                processed  in  a  single  queue run.  If not
                set, there is no limit on the size.  If  you
                have very large queues or a very short queue
                run  interval  this could be unstable.  How-
                ever, since the first N jobs in queue direc-
                tory  order  are  run  (rather  than  the  N










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-119


                highest priority jobs) this should be set as
                high as possible to avoid "losing" jobs that
                happen  to fall late in the queue directory.
                Note: this option also restricts the  number
                of  entries  printed  by mailq.  That is, if
                MaxQueueRunSize is set to a value  N  larger
                than  zero,  then only N entries are printed
                per queue group.

      MaxRecipientsPerMessage=N
                The maximum number of recipients  that  will
                be  accepted per message in an SMTP transac-
                tion.  Note: setting this too low can inter-
                fere with sending mail from  MUAs  that  use
                SMTP  for  initial  submission.  If not set,
                there is no limit on the number  of  recipi-
                ents per envelope.

      MaxRunnersPerQueue=N
                This  sets  the  default  maximum  number of
                queue runners for queue  groups.   Up  to  N
                queue  runners  will  work  in parallel on a
                queue  group's  messages.   This  is  useful
                where  the  processing  of  a message in the
                queue might delay the processing  of  subse-
                quent  messages. Such a delay may be the re-
                sult of non-erroneous situations such  as  a
                low bandwidth connection.  May be overridden
                on  a  per  queue group basis by setting the
                Runners option; see the section Queue  Group
                Declaration.  The default is 1 when not set.

      MeToo     [m] Send to me too, even if I am in an alias
                expansion.   This  option  is deprecated and
                will be removed from a future version.

      Milter    This  option  has  several  sub(sub)options.
                The names of the suboptions are separated by
                dots.   At the first level the following op-
                tions are available:

                    LogLevel   Log level for input mail filter actions, defaults to LogLevel.
                    macros     Specifies list of macro to transmit to filters.
                               See list below.

                The ``macros'' option has the following sub-
                options which specify the list of  macro  to
                transmit  to  milters  after a certain event
                occurred.














SMM:08-120         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                    connect   After session connection start
                    helo      After EHLO/HELO command
                    envfrom   After MAIL command
                    envrcpt   After RCPT command
                    data      After DATA command.
                    eoh       After DATA command and header
                    eom       After DATA command and terminating ``.''

                By default the lists of  macros  are  empty.
                Example:

                    O Milter.LogLevel=12
                    O Milter.macros.connect=j, _, {daemon_name}


      MinFreeBlocks=N
                [b]  Insist on at least N blocks free on the
                filesystem that holds the queue files before
                accepting email via SMTP.  If there  is  in-
                sufficient  space  sendmail  gives a 452 re-
                sponse to the MAIL  command.   This  invites
                the sender to try again later.

      MaxQueueAge=age
                If this is set to a value greater than zero,
                entries  in the queue will be retried during
                a queue run only  if  the  individual  retry
                time  has  been reached which is doubled for
                each attempt.  The  maximum  retry  time  is
                limited by the specified value.

      MinQueueAge=age
                Don't process any queued jobs that have been
                in  the  queue  less than the indicated time
                interval.  This is intended to allow you  to
                get  responsiveness  by processing the queue
                fairly  frequently  without  thrashing  your
                system  by  trying  jobs too often.  The de-
                fault units are minutes.  Note: This  option
                is ignored for queue runs that select a sub-
                set       of      the      queue,      i.e.,
                "-q[!][I|R|S|Q][string]"

      MustQuoteChars=s
                Sets the list of  characters  that  must  be
                quoted if used in a full name that is in the
                phrase  part  of a ``phrase <address>'' syn-
                tax.  The default is ``'.''.  The characters
                ``@,;:\()[]'' are always added to this list.
                Note: To avoid potential  breakage  of  DKIM
                signatures it is useful to set

                    O MustQuoteChars=.










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-121


                Moreover,  relaxed  header signing should be
                used for DKIM signatures.

      NiceQueueRun
                The priority  of  queue  runners  (nice(3)).
                This value must be greater or equal zero.

      NoRecipientAction
                The  action  to take when you receive a mes-
                sage that has  no  valid  recipient  headers
                (To:,  Cc:,  Bcc:,  or Apparently-To: -- the
                last included for  back  compatibility  with
                old  sendmails).  It can be None to pass the
                message on unmodified,  which  violates  the
                protocol,  Add-To  to  add a To: header with
                any recipients it can find in  the  envelope
                (which  might  expose Bcc: recipients), Add-
                Apparently-To  to  add   an   Apparently-To:
                header  (this is only for back-compatibility
                and is officially deprecated), Add-To-Undis-
                closed to add a header "To:  undisclosed-re-
                cipients:;" to make the header legal without
                disclosing  anything,  or  Add-Bcc to add an
                empty Bcc: header.

      OldStyleHeaders
                [o] Assume that the headers may  be  in  old
                format,  i.e.,  spaces  delimit names.  This
                actually turns on an adaptive algorithm:  if
                any  recipient  address  contains  a  comma,
                parenthesis, or angle bracket,  it  will  be
                assumed  that commas already exist.  If this
                flag is not on, only commas  delimit  names.
                Headers  are  always  output with commas be-
                tween the names.  Defaults to off.

      OperatorChars=charlist
                [$o macro] The list of characters  that  are
                considered to be "operators", that is, char-
                acters  that  delimit  tokens.  All operator
                characters are  tokens  by  themselves;  se-
                quences  of non-operator characters are also
                tokens.  White space characters separate to-
                kens but are not tokens  themselves  --  for
                example,  "AAA.BBB"  has  three  tokens, but
                "AAA BBB" has two.  If  not  set,  Operator-
                Chars defaults to ".:@[]"; additionally, the
                characters  "()<>,;"  are  always operators.
                Note that OperatorChars must be set  in  the
                configuration file before any rulesets.

      PidFile=filename
                Filename  of  the  pid  file.   (default  is










SMM:08-122         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                _PATH_SENDMAILPID).  The filename is  macro-
                expanded  before  it is opened, and unlinked
                when sendmail exits.

      PostmasterCopy=postmaster
                [P] If set, copies of error messages will be
                sent to  the  named  postmaster.   Only  the
                header  of  the failed message is sent.  Er-
                rors resulting from messages with a negative
                precedence will not be sent.  Since most er-
                rors are user problems, this is probably not
                a good idea on  large  sites,  and  arguably
                contains  all  sorts  of privacy violations,
                but it seems to be popular with certain  op-
                erating  systems  vendors.   The  address is
                macro expanded at the time of delivery.  De-
                faults to no postmaster copies.

      PrivacyOptions=opt,opt,...
                [p] Set the privacy options.  ``Privacy'' is
                really a misnomer; many of these are just  a
                way  of  insisting  on stricter adherence to
                the SMTP protocol.  The options can  be  se-
                lected from:

                    public              Allow open access
                    needmailhelo        Insist on HELO or EHLO command before MAIL
                    needexpnhelo        Insist on HELO or EHLO command before EXPN
                    noexpn              Disallow EXPN entirely, implies noverb.
                    needvrfyhelo        Insist on HELO or EHLO command before VRFY
                    novrfy              Disallow VRFY entirely
                    noetrn              Disallow ETRN entirely
                    noverb              Disallow VERB entirely
                    restrictmailq       Restrict mailq command
                    restrictqrun        Restrict -q command line flag
                    restrictexpand      Restrict -bv and -v command line flags
                    noreceipts          Don't return success DSNs[20]
                    nobodyreturn        Don't return the body of a message with DSNs
                    goaway              Disallow essentially all SMTP status queries
                    authwarnings        Put X-Authentication-Warning: headers in messages
                                        and log warnings
                    noactualrecipient   Don't put X-Actual-Recipient lines in DSNs
                                        which reveal the actual account that addresses map to.

                The "goaway" pseudo-flag sets all flags  ex-
                cept   "noreceipts",  "restrictmailq",  "re-
                strictqrun", "restrictexpand", "noetrn", and
                "nobodyreturn".   If  mailq  is  restricted,
____________________
   [20]N.B.:  the  noreceipts flag turns off support for RFC
1891 (Delivery Status Notification).












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-123


                only  people  in the same group as the queue
                directory can print  the  queue.   If  queue
                runs are restricted, only root and the owner
                of  the  queue  directory can run the queue.
                The "restrictexpand"  pseudo-flag  instructs
                sendmail to drop privileges when the -bv op-
                tion  is given by users who are neither root
                nor the TrustedUser  so  users  cannot  read
                private   aliases,  forwards,  or  :include:
                files.  It will add the "NonRootSafeAddr" to
                the "DontBlameSendmail"  option  to  prevent
                misleading unsafe address warnings.  It also
                overrides  the -v (verbose) command line op-
                tion to prevent  information  leakage.   Au-
                thentication  Warnings  add  warnings  about
                various conditions  that  may  indicate  at-
                tempts to spoof the mail system, such as us-
                ing a non-standard queue directory.

      ProcessTitlePrefix=string
                Prefix the process title shown on 'ps' list-
                ings  with string.  The string will be macro
                processed.

      QueueDirectory=dir
                [Q] The  QueueDirectory  option  serves  two
                purposes.  First, it specifies the directory
                or  set of directories that comprise the de-
                fault queue group.  Second, it specifies the
                directory D which is  the  ancestor  of  all
                queue  directories,  and which sendmail uses
                as  its  current  working  directory.   When
                sendmail  dumps  core,  it  leaves  its core
                files in D.  There are two  cases.   If  dir
                ends      with      an     asterisk     (eg,
                /var/spool/mqueue/qd*), then all of the  di-
                rectories  or  symbolic links to directories
                beginning  with  `qd'  in  /var/spool/mqueue
                will be used as queue directories of the de-
                fault  queue  group,  and  /var/spool/mqueue
                will be used as  the  working  directory  D.
                Otherwise,  dir  must name a directory (usu-
                ally /var/spool/mqueue): the  default  queue
                group consists of the single queue directory
                dir,  and  the working directory D is set to
                dir.  To define additional groups  of  queue
                directories,  use the configuration file `Q'
                command.  Do not change the queue  directory
                structure while sendmail is running.

      QueueFactor=factor
                [q]  Use factor as the multiplier in the map
                function to decide when  to  just  queue  up










SMM:08-124         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                jobs  rather  than  run them.  This value is
                divided by the difference between  the  cur-
                rent load average and the load average limit
                (QueueLA  option)  to  determine the maximum
                message priority that  will  be  sent.   De-
                faults to 600000.

      QueueLA=LA
                [x]  When the system load average exceeds LA
                and the QueueFactor (q)  option  divided  by
                the  difference  in the current load average
                and the QueueLA option plus one is less than
                the priority of the message, just queue mes-
                sages (i.e., don't try to send  them).   De-
                faults  to  8  multiplied  by  the number of
                processors online on the system (if that can
                be determined).

      QueueFileMode=mode
                Default permissions for queue files (octal).
                If not set, sendmail uses  0600  unless  its
                real  and  effective  uid  are  different in
                which case it uses 0644.

      QueueSortOrder=algorithm
                Sets the  algorithm  used  for  sorting  the
                queue.   Only  the  first  character  of the
                value is used.  Legal values are "host"  (to
                order  by the name of the first host name of
                the first recipient), "filename"  (to  order
                by  the name of the queue file name), "time"
                (to order by the submission/creation  time),
                "random" (to order randomly), "modification"
                (to order by the modification time of the qf
                file  (older entries first)), "none" (to not
                order), and "priority" (to order by  message
                priority).   Host  ordering makes better use
                of the connection cache,  but  may  tend  to
                process  low  priority messages that go to a
                single host over high priority messages that
                go to several hosts; it  probably  shouldn't
                be used on slow network links.  Filename and
                modification  time  ordering saves the over-
                head of reading all of the queued items  be-
                fore starting the queue run.  Creation (sub-
                mission)  time  ordering  is almost always a
                bad idea, since it allows large,  bulk  mail
                to go out before smaller, personal mail, but
                may  have  applicability  on some hosts with
                very fast connections.  Random is useful  if
                several  queue  runners  are started by hand
                which try to drain the same queue since odds
                are they will be working on different  parts










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-125


                of the queue at the same time.  Priority or-
                dering is the default.

      QueueTimeout=timeout
                [T]  A  synonym  for  "Timeout.queuereturn".
                Use that form instead of the  "QueueTimeout"
                form.

      RandFile  Name  of  file containing random data or the
                name of the UNIX socket if EGD is  used.   A
                (required)  prefix  "egd:" or "file:" speci-
                fies the type.  STARTTLS requires this file-
                name if the compile  flag  HASURANDOMDEV  is
                not set (see sendmail/README).

      ResolverOptions=options
                [I] Set resolver options.  Values can be set
                using  +flag  and  cleared  using -flag; the
                flags can  be  "debug",  "aaonly",  "usevc",
                "primary",  "igntc",  "recurse", "defnames",
                "stayopen", "use_inet6", or  "dnsrch".   The
                string  "HasWildcardMX"  (without  a + or -)
                can  be  specified  to  turn  off   matching
                against MX records when doing name canonifi-
                cations.   The string "WorkAroundBrokenAAAA"
                (without a + or -) can be specified to  work
                around  some broken nameservers which return
                SERVFAIL (a  temporary  failure)  on  T_AAAA
                (IPv6)  lookups.  Notice: it might be neces-
                sary to apply the same (or similar)  options
                to submit.cf too.

      RequiresDirfsync
                This option can be used to override the com-
                pile time flag REQUIRES_DIR_FSYNC at runtime
                by setting it to false.  If the compile time
                flag is not set, the option is ignored.  The
                flag  turns on support for file systems that
                require to call fsync() for a  directory  if
                the  meta-data in it has been changed.  This
                should be turned on at least for older  ver-
                sions  of ReiserFS; it is enabled by default
                for Linux.  According  to  some  information
                this  flag  is not needed anymore for kernel
                2.4.16 and newer.

      RrtImpliesDsn
                If this option is  set,  a  "Return-Receipt-
                To:"  header  causes  the  request of a DSN,
                which is sent to the envelope sender as  re-
                quired by RFC 1891, not to the address given
                in the header.











SMM:08-126         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      RunAsUser=user
                The  user  parameter  may  be  a  user  name
                (looked up in /etc/passwd) or a numeric user
                id; either form can have  ":group"  attached
                (where  group  can  be numeric or symbolic).
                If set to a non-zero (non-root) value, send-
                mail will change to this user id shortly af-
                ter  startup[21].   This  avoids  a  certain
                class of security problems.   However,  this
                means  that  all  ".forward" and ":include:"
                files must be readable by the indicated user
                and all files to be written must be writable
                by user Also, all file and program  deliver-
                ies  will be marked unsafe unless the option
                DontBlameSendmail=NonRootSafeAddr is set, in
                which case the  delivery  will  be  done  as
                user.   It  is  also  incompatible  with the
                SafeFileEnvironment option.  In other words,
                it may not actually add much to security  on
                an  average  system, and may in fact detract
                from security (because  other  file  permis-
                sions must be loosened).  However, it should
                be  useful  on  firewalls  and  other places
                where users  don't  have  accounts  and  the
                aliases file is well constrained.

      RecipientFactor=fact
                [y]  The  indicated  factor  is added to the
                priority (thus lowering the priority of  the
                job)  for  each  recipient, i.e., this value
                penalizes jobs with large numbers of recipi-
                ents.  Defaults to 30000.

      RefuseLA=LA
                [X] When the system load average exceeds LA,
                refuse incoming SMTP connections.   Defaults
                to 12 multiplied by the number of processors
                online  on the system (if that can be deter-
                mined).

      RejectLogInterval=timeout
                Log interval when refusing  connections  for
                this long (default: 3h).

      RetryFactor=fact
                [Z]  The  factor  is  added  to the priority
                every time a job is processed.   Thus,  each
____________________
   [21]When running as a daemon, it changes to this user af-
ter accepting a connection but before reading any SMTP  com-
mands.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-127


                time  a  job is processed, its priority will
                be decreased by  the  indicated  value.   In
                most  environments  this should be positive,
                since hosts that are down are all too  often
                down for a long time.  Defaults to 90000.

      SafeFileEnvironment=dir
                If  this  option  is set, sendmail will do a
                chroot(2) call into the indicated  directory
                before  doing  any file writes.  If the file
                name specified by the user begins with  dir,
                that  partial path name will be stripped off
                before writing,  so  (for  example)  if  the
                SafeFileEnvironment   variable   is  set  to
                "/safe" then  aliases  of  "/safe/logs/file"
                and  "/logs/file" actually indicate the same
                file.  Additionally, if this option is  set,
                sendmail  refuses  to  deliver  to  symbolic
                links.

      SaveFromLine
                [f] Save  UNIX-style  "From"  lines  at  the
                front of headers.  Normally they are assumed
                redundant and discarded.

      SendMimeErrors
                [j] If set, send error messages in MIME for-
                mat (see RFC 2045 and RFC 1344 for details).
                If  disabled,  sendmail  will not return the
                DSN keyword in response to an EHLO and  will
                not do Delivery Status Notification process-
                ing as described in RFC 1891.

      ServerCertFile
                File   containing  the  certificate  of  the
                server, i.e., this certificate is used  when
                sendmail acts as server (used for STARTTLS).

      ServerKeyFile
                File containing the private key belonging to
                the server certificate (used for STARTTLS).

      ServerSSLOptions
                A  space  or comma separated list of SSL re-
                lated options  for  the  server  side.   See
                SSL_CTX_set_options(3)   for   a  list;  the
                available values depend on the OpenSSL  ver-
                sion against which sendmail is compiled.  By
                default,  SSL_OP_ALL  -SSL_OP_TLSEXT_PADDING
                are used (if those options  are  available).
                Options  can  be  cleared  by preceding them
                with a minus sign.  It is also  possible  to
                specify numerical values, e.g., -0x0010.










SMM:08-128         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      ServiceSwitchFile=filename
                If  your host operating system has a service
                switch abstraction (e.g., /etc/nsswitch.conf
                on Solaris or /etc/svc.conf  on  Ultrix  and
                DEC  OSF/1)  that  service will be consulted
                and this option is ignored.  Otherwise, this
                is the name of a file that provides the list
                of methods used to implement particular ser-
                vices.  The syntax is  a  series  of  lines,
                each  of  which is a sequence of words.  The
                first word is the service name, and  follow-
                ing  words  are service types.  The services
                that   sendmail   consults   directly    are
                "aliases" and "hosts."  Service types can be
                "dns",  "nis",  "nisplus",  or "files" (with
                the caveat that the appropriate support must
                be compiled in before  the  service  can  be
                referenced).   If  ServiceSwitchFile  is not
                specified,  it  defaults  to  /etc/mail/ser-
                vice.switch.   If  that file does not exist,
                the default switch is:

                    aliases             files
                    hosts               dns nis files

                The   default   file   is    "/etc/mail/ser-
                vice.switch".

      SevenBitInput
                [7]  Strip  input to seven bits for compati-
                bility with old systems.  This shouldn't  be
                necessary.

      SharedMemoryKey
                Key to use for shared memory segment; if not
                set  (or 0), shared memory will not be used.
                If set to -1 sendmail can select a  key  it-
                self  provided that also SharedMemoryKeyFile
                is set.  Requires support for shared  memory
                to  be  compiled into sendmail.  If this op-
                tion is set, sendmail can  share  some  data
                between  different  instances.  For example,
                the number of entries in a  queue  directory
                or  the  available  space  in a file system.
                This allows for more efficient program  exe-
                cution,  since only one process needs to up-
                date the data  instead  of  each  individual
                process  gathering  the data each time it is
                required.

      SharedMemoryKeyFile
                If SharedMemoryKey is set to -1 then the au-
                tomatically selected shared memory key  will










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-129


                be stored in the specified file.

      SingleLineFromHeader
                If  set, From: lines that have embedded new-
                lines are unwrapped onto one line.  This  is
                to  get  around  a botch in Lotus Notes that
                apparently cannot understand legally wrapped
                RFC 822 headers.

      SingleThreadDelivery
                If set, a client machine will never  try  to
                open two SMTP connections to a single server
                machine  at the same time, even in different
                processes.  That is, if another sendmail  is
                already  talking to some host a new sendmail
                will  not  open  another  connection.   This
                property  is  of  mixed value; although this
                reduces the load on the  other  machine,  it
                can  cause  mail to be delayed (for example,
                if one sendmail is delivering  a  huge  mes-
                sage,  other sendmails won't be able to send
                even small messages).  Also, it requires an-
                other file descriptor (for  the  lock  file)
                per  connection,  so  you may have to reduce
                the ConnectionCacheSize option to avoid run-
                ning out of  per-process  file  descriptors.
                Requires the HostStatusDirectory option.

      SmtpGreetingMessage=message
                [$e macro] The message printed when the SMTP
                server  starts up.  Defaults to "$j Sendmail
                $v ready at $b".

      SMTPUTF8  Enable runtime support for SMTPUTF8.

      SoftBounce
                If set, issue temporary errors (4xy) instead
                of permanent errors (5xy).  This can be use-
                ful during testing of a new configuration to
                avoid erroneous bouncing of mails.

      SSLEngine Name of SSL engine to  use.   The  available
                values depend on the OpenSSL version against
                which sendmail is compiled, see

                    openssl engine -v

                for some information.

      SSLEnginePath
                Path  to  dynamic  library  for  SSL engine.
                This option is only useful if  SSLEngine  is
                set.   If  both  are set, the engine will be










SMM:08-130         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                loaded dynamically at runtime using the con-
                catenation of the path,  a  slash  "/",  the
                string  "lib",  the  value of SSLEngine, and
                the string ".so".  If only SSLEngine is  set
                then  the  static  version  of the engine is
                used.

      StatusFile=file
                [S] Log  summary  statistics  in  the  named
                file.   If  no file name is specified, "sta-
                tistics" is used.  If not  set,  no  summary
                statistics  are  saved.   This file does not
                grow in size.  It can be printed  using  the
                mailstats(8) program.

      SuperSafe [s]  This  option can be set to True, False,
                Interactive, or PostMilter.  If set to True,
                sendmail will  be  super-safe  when  running
                things,  i.e.,  always instantiate the queue
                file, even if you are going to attempt imme-
                diate delivery.  Sendmail  always  instanti-
                ates the queue file before returning control
                to the client under any circumstances.  This
                should  really  always  be set to True.  The
                Interactive value  has  been  introduced  in
                8.12 and can be used together with Delivery-
                Mode=i.  It skips some synchronization calls
                which  are  effectively  doubled in the code
                execution path for this  mode.   If  set  to
                PostMilter,  sendmail  defers  synchronizing
                the queue file until any milters  have  sig-
                naled acceptance of the message.  PostMilter
                is  useful  only when sendmail is running as
                an SMTP server; in all other  situations  it
                acts the same as True.

      TLSFallbacktoClear
                If  set,  sendmail immediately tries an out-
                bound connection again without STARTTLS  af-
                ter a TLS handshake failure.  Note: this ap-
                plies  to  all  connections even if TLS spe-
                cific requirements  are  set  (see  rulesets
                tls_rcpt  and  tls_client ).  Hence such re-
                quirements will cause an error  on  a  retry
                without  STARTTLS.   Therefore  they  should
                only trigger a temporary failure so the con-
                nection is later on tried again.

      TLSSrvOptions
                List of options for SMTP  STARTTLS  for  the
                server  consisting of single characters with
                intervening white space or commas.  The flag
                ``V''  disables  client  verification,   and










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-131


                hence  it  is  not  possible to use a client
                certificate for relaying.   The  flag  ``C''
                removes  the  requirement for the TLS server
                to have a cert.  This only works under  very
                specific  circumstances  and  should only be
                used if  the  consequences  are  understood,
                e.g., clients may not work with a server us-
                ing this.

      TempFileMode=mode
                [F]  The  file  mode  for  transcript files,
                files to which sendmail  delivers  directly,
                files  in  the HostStatusDirectory, and Sta-
                tusFile.  It is interpreted in octal by  de-
                fault.  Defaults to 0600.

      Timeout.type=timeout
                [r; subsumes old T option as well] Set time-
                out  values.  For more information, see sec-
                tion 4.1.

      TimeZoneSpec=tzinfo
                [t] Set the local time zone info  to  tzinfo
                --  for  example,  "PST8PDT".   Actually, if
                this is not set, the TZ environment variable
                is cleared (so the system default is  used);
                if  set  but null, the user's TZ variable is
                used, and if set and non-null the  TZ  vari-
                able is set to this value.

      TrustedUser=user
                The  user  parameter  may  be  a  user  name
                (looked up in /etc/passwd) or a numeric user
                id.  Trusted user  for  file  ownership  and
                starting  the  daemon.   If  set,  generated
                alias databases and the control  socket  (if
                configured)  will  automatically be owned by
                this user.

      TryNullMXList
                [w] If this system is the "best"  (that  is,
                lowest  preference) MX for a given host, its
                configuration rules should  normally  detect
                this situation and treat that condition spe-
                cially  by  forwarding  the  mail  to a UUCP
                feed, treating it  as  local,  or  whatever.
                However,  in  some  cases  (such as Internet
                firewalls) you may want to  try  to  connect
                directly to that host as though it had no MX
                records  at all.  Setting this option causes
                sendmail to try this.  The downside is  that
                errors  in  your configuration are likely to
                be diagnosed as "host unknown"  or  "message










SMM:08-132         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                timed  out"  instead of something more mean-
                ingful.  This option is disrecommended.

      UnixFromLine=fromline
                [$l macro]  Defines  the  format  used  when
                sendmail  must  add  a UNIX-style From_ line
                (that     is,     a      line      beginning
                "From<space>user").   Defaults  to  "From $g
                $d".  Don't change this unless  your  system
                uses  a  different UNIX mailbox format (very
                unlikely).

      UnsafeGroupWrites
                If set  (default),  :include:  and  .forward
                files that are group writable are considered
                "unsafe",  that  is,  they  cannot reference
                programs or write directly to files.   World
                writable  :include:  and  .forward files are
                always unsafe.  Note: use  DontBlameSendmail
                instead; this option is deprecated.

      UseCompressedIPv6Addresses
                If  set,  the  compressed format of IPv6 ad-
                dresses, such as IPV6:::1, will be used, in-
                stead of the uncompressed  format,  such  as
                IPv6:0:0:0:0:0:0:0:1.

      UseErrorsTo
                [l] If there is an "Errors-To:" header, send
                error   messages  to  the  addresses  listed
                there.  They normally  go  to  the  envelope
                sender.   Use of this option causes sendmail
                to violate RFC 1123.  This option is disrec-
                ommended and deprecated.

      UserDatabaseSpec=udbspec
                [U] The user database specification.

      Verbose   [v] Run in verbose mode.  If  this  is  set,
                sendmail  adjusts options HoldExpensive (old
                c) and DeliveryMode (old d) so that all mail
                is delivered completely in a single  job  so
                that   you   can  see  the  entire  delivery
                process.  Option Verbose should never be set
                in the configuration file;  it  is  intended
                for  command  line  use only.  Note that the
                use of option Verbose can cause  authentica-
                tion information to leak, if you use a send-
                mail client to authenticate to a server.  If
                the authentication mechanism uses plain text
                passwords (as with LOGIN or PLAIN), then the
                password  could  be  compromised.   To avoid
                this, do not  install  sendmail  set-user-ID










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-133


                root, and disable the VERB SMTP command with
                a suitable PrivacyOptions setting.

      XscriptFileBufferSize=threshold
                Set  the  threshold, in bytes, before a mem-
                ory-based  queue  transcript  file   becomes
                disk-based.  The default is 4096 bytes.

      All options can be specified on the command line using
      the -O or -o flag, but most will cause sendmail to re-
      linquish  its  set-user-ID  permissions.   The options
      that will not cause this are SevenBitInput [7], Eight-
      BitMode  [8],  MinFreeBlocks  [b],  CheckpointInterval
      [C],  DeliveryMode [d], ErrorMode [e], IgnoreDots [i],
      SendMimeErrors [j], LogLevel [L], MeToo [m], OldStyle-
      Headers [o], PrivacyOptions [p], SuperSafe  [s],  Ver-
      bose [v], QueueSortOrder, MinQueueAge, DefaultCharSet,
      Dial  Delay,  NoRecipientAction,  ColonOkInAddr,  Max-
      QueueRunSize, SingleLineFromHeader,  and  AllowBogusH-
      ELO.   Actually,  PrivacyOptions [p] given on the com-
      mand line are added to those already specified in  the
      sendmail.cf  file, i.e., they can't be reset.  Also, M
      (define macro) when defining the r or s macros is also
      considered "safe".

   5.8.  P -- Precedence Definitions

           Values for the "Precedence:" field may be defined
      using the P control line.  The syntax  of  this  field
      is:

          Pname=num

      When  the  name is found in a "Precedence:" field, the
      message class is set  to  num.   Higher  numbers  mean
      higher  precedence.   Numbers  less than zero have the
      special property that if an error occurs  during  pro-
      cessing  the body of the message will not be returned;
      this is expected to be used for "bulk"  mail  such  as
      through  mailing  lists.   The  default  precedence is
      zero.  For example, our list of precedences is:

          Pfirst-class=0
          Pspecial-delivery=100
          Plist=-30
          Pbulk=-60
          Pjunk=-100

      People writing mailing list exploders  are  encouraged
      to use "Precedence: list".  Older versions of sendmail
      (which discarded all error returns for negative prece-
      dences)  didn't  recognize  this name, giving it a de-
      fault  precedence   of   zero.    This   allows   list










SMM:08-134         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      maintainers  to  see error returns on both old and new
      versions of sendmail.

   5.9.  V -- Configuration Version Level

           To provide compatibility with  old  configuration
      files,  the  V line has been added to define some very
      basic semantics of the configuration file.  These  are
      not  intended  to  be long term supports; rather, they
      describe compatibility features which will probably be
      removed in future releases.

           N.B.: these version levels  have  nothing  to  do
      with the version number on the files.  For example, as
      of this writing version 10 config files (specifically,
      8.10) used version level 9 configurations.

           "Old"  configuration files are defined as version
      level one.  Version level two files make the following
      changes:

       (1)   Host name canonification ($[ ... $]) appends  a
             dot  if  the name is recognized; this gives the
             config file a way of finding  out  if  anything
             matched.   (Actually, this just initializes the
             "host" map with the "-a."  flag -- you can  re-
             set  it to anything you prefer by declaring the
             map explicitly.)

       (2)   Default  host  name  extension  is   consistent
             throughout  processing;  version level one con-
             figurations turned off domain  extension  (that
             is,  adding  the local domain name) during cer-
             tain points in processing.  Version  level  two
             configurations are expected to include a trail-
             ing  dot  to  indicate that the name is already
             canonical.

       (3)   Local names that are  not  aliases  are  passed
             through  a new distinguished ruleset five; this
             can be used to append a local relay.  This  be-
             havior  can be prevented by resolving the local
             name with an initial `@'.  That  is,  something
             that resolves to a local mailer and a user name
             of "vikki" will be passed through ruleset five,
             but  a  user name of "@vikki" will have the `@'
             stripped, will not be  passed  through  ruleset
             five, but will otherwise be treated the same as
             the  prior  example.   The  expectation is that
             this might be used to implement a policy  where
             mail  sent  to "vikki" was handled by a central
             hub, but mail sent to "vikki@localhost" was de-
             livered directly.










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-135


           Version level three files allow # initiated  com-
      ments  on all lines.  Exceptions are backslash escaped
      # marks and the $# syntax.

           Version level four configurations are  completely
      equivalent to level three for historical reasons.

           Version level five configuration files change the
      default  definition  of $w to be just the first compo-
      nent of the hostname.

           Version level six configuration files change many
      of the local processing options (such as aliasing  and
      matching  the beginning of the address for `|' charac-
      ters) to be mailer  flags;  this  allows  fine-grained
      control  over the special local processing.  Level six
      configuration files may also use  long  option  names.
      The  ColonOkInAddr  option (to allow colons in the lo-
      cal-part of addresses) defaults on for lower  numbered
      configuration  files;  the configuration file requires
      some additional intelligence to  properly  handle  the
      RFC 822 group construct.

           Version  level seven configuration files used new
      option names to replace old macros  ($e  became  Smtp-
      GreetingMessage, $l became UnixFromLine, and $o became
      OperatorChars.   Also, prior to version seven, the F=q
      flag (use 250 instead of 252  return  value  for  SMTP
      VRFY commands) was assumed.

           Version  level eight configuration files allow $#
      on the left hand side of ruleset lines.

           Version  level  nine  configuration  files  allow
      parentheses  in rulesets, i.e. they are not treated as
      comments and hence removed.

           Version level ten configuration files allow queue
      group definitions.

           The V line may have an optional /vendor to  indi-
      cate  that  this configuration file uses modifications
      specific to a  particular  vendor[22].   You  may  use
      "/Berkeley"  to emphasize that this configuration file
      uses the Berkeley dialect of sendmail.

____________________
   [22]And of course, vendors are encouraged  to  add  them-
selves to the list of recognized vendors by editing the rou-
tine  setvendor  in  conf.c.   Please  send  e-mail to send-
mail@Sendmail.ORG to register your vendor dialect.












SMM:08-136         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


   5.10.  K -- Key File Declaration

           Special maps can be defined using the line:

          Kmapname mapclass arguments

      The mapname is the handle by which this map is  refer-
      enced  in  the  rewriting  rules.  The mapclass is the
      name of a type of map; these are compiled in to  send-
      mail.   The arguments are interpreted depending on the
      class; typically, there would  be  a  single  argument
      naming the file containing the map.

           Maps are referenced using the syntax:

          $( map key $@ arguments $: default $)

      where  either or both of the arguments or default por-
      tion may be omitted.  The $@ arguments may appear more
      than once.  The indicated key and arguments are passed
      to the appropriate mapping function.  If it returns  a
      value, it replaces the input.  If it does not return a
      value  and  the  default is specified, the default re-
      places the input.  Otherwise, the input is unchanged.

           The arguments are passed to the map for arbitrary
      use.  Most map classes can interpolate these arguments
      into their values using the syntax "%n" (where n is  a
      digit)  to indicate the corresponding argument.  Argu-
      ment "%0" indicates the database  key.   For  example,
      the rule

          R$- ! $+       $: $(uucp $1 $@ $2 $: $2 @ $1 . UUCP $)

      looks  up  the UUCP name in a (user defined) UUCP map;
      if not found it turns it into ".UUCP" form.  The data-
      base might contain records like:

          decvax         %1@%0.DEC.COM
          research       %1@%0.ATT.COM

      Note that default clauses never do this mapping.

           The built-in map with both name and class  "host"
      is  the  host name canonicalization lookup.  Thus, the
      syntax:

          $(host hostname$)

      is equivalent to:

          $[hostname$]











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-137


           There are many defined classes.

      cdb       Database lookups using the  cdb(3)  library.
                Sendmail must be compiled with CDB defined.

      dbm       Database  lookups using the ndbm(3) library.
                Sendmail must be compiled with NDBM defined.

      btree     Database lookups using the  btree  interface
                to  the  Berkeley DB library.  Sendmail must
                be compiled with NEWDB defined.

      hash      Database lookups using the hash interface to
                the Berkeley DB library.  Sendmail  must  be
                compiled with NEWDB defined.

      nis       NIS lookups.  Sendmail must be compiled with
                NIS defined.

      nisplus   NIS+  lookups.   Sendmail  must  be compiled
                with NISPLUS defined.  The argument  is  the
                name  of  the  table to use for lookups, and
                the -k and -v flags may be used to  set  the
                key and value columns respectively.

      hesiod    Hesiod  lookups.   Sendmail must be compiled
                with HESIOD defined.

      ldap      LDAP X500 directory lookups.  Sendmail  must
                be  compiled  with LDAPMAP defined.  The map
                supports most of the standard arguments  and
                most  of  the  command line arguments of the
                ldapsearch program.  Note that, by  default,
                if  a  single query matches multiple values,
                only the first value will be returned unless
                the -z (value separator) map option is  set.
                Also,  the -1 map flag will treat a multiple
                value return as if there were no matches.

      netinfo   NeXT NetInfo lookups.  Sendmail must be com-
                piled with NETINFO defined.

      text      Text file lookups.  The format of  the  text
                file  is  defined  by the -k (key field num-
                ber), -v (value field number), and -z (field
                delimiter) options.

      ph        PH query map.  Contributed and supported  by
                Mark Roth, roth@uiuc.edu.

      nsd       nsd map for IRIX 6.5 and later.  Contributed
                and   supported   by   Bob   Mende  of  SGI,
                mende@sgi.com.










SMM:08-138         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      stab      Internal symbol table lookups.  Used  inter-
                nally for aliasing.

      implicit  Sequentially  try  a  list  of available map
                types: hash, dbm, and cdb.  It  is  the  de-
                fault  for alias files if no class is speci-
                fied.  If is no matching map type is  found,
                the text version is used for the alias file,
                but other maps fail to open.

      user      Looks  up  users  using getpwnam(3).  The -v
                flag can be used to specify the name of  the
                field  to  return (although this is normally
                used only to check the existence of a user).

      host      Canonifies host domain names.  Given a  host
                name  it  calls  the name server to find the
                canonical name for that host.

      bestmx    Returns the best MX record for a  host  name
                given  as  the  key.  The current machine is
                always preferred -- that is, if the  current
                machine is one of the hosts listed as a low-
                est-preference  MX  record,  then it will be
                guaranteed to be returned.  This can be used
                to find out if this machine  is  the  target
                for  an  MX record, and mail can be accepted
                on that basis.  If the -z option  is  given,
                then all MX names are returned, separated by
                the given delimiter.  Note: the return value
                is  deterministic, i.e., even if multiple MX
                records have the same preference, they  will
                be returned in the same order.

      dns       This  map  requires the option -R to specify
                the DNS resource record type to lookup.  The
                following  types  are  supported:  A,  AAAA,
                AFSDB,  CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT.  A
                map lookup will return only one  record  un-
                less the -z (value separator) option is set.
                Hence  for some types, e.g., MX records, the
                return value might be a  random  element  of
                the  results  due  to randomizing in the DNS
                resolver, if only one element is returned.

      arpa      Returns the ``reverse''  for  the  given  IP
                (IPv4 or IPv6) address, i.e., the string for
                the   PTR   lookup,   but  without  trailing
                ip6.arpa or in-addr.arpa.  For example,  the
                following configuration lines:













Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-139


                    Karpa arpa
                    SArpa
                    R$+            $: $(arpa $1 $)

                work like this in test mode:

                    sendmail -bt
                    ADDRESS TEST MODE (ruleset 3 NOT automatically invoked)
                    Enter <ruleset> <address>
                    > Arpa IPv6:1:2:dead:beef:9876:0:0:1
                    Arpa               input: IPv6 : 1 : 2 : dead : beef : 9876 : 0 : 0 : 1
                    Arpa             returns: 1 . 0 . 0 . 0 . 0 . 0 . 0 . 0 . 0 . 0 . 0 . 0 . 6 . 7 . 8 . 9 . f . e . e . b . d . a . e . d . 2 . 0 . 0 . 0 . 1 . 0 . 0 . 0
                    > Arpa 1.2.3.4
                    Arpa               input: 1 . 2 . 3 . 4
                    Arpa             returns: 4 . 3 . 2 . 1


      sequence  The  arguments on the `K' line are a list of
                maps; the resulting map searches  the  argu-
                ment  maps  in  order until it finds a match
                for the indicated key.  For example, if  the
                key definition is:

                    Kmap1 ...
                    Kmap2 ...
                    Kseqmap sequence map1 map2

                then  a lookup against "seqmap" first does a
                lookup in map1.  If that is  found,  it  re-
                turns  immediately.  Otherwise, the same key
                is used for map2.

      syslog    the  key  is  logged  via  syslogd(8).   The
                lookup returns the empty string.

      switch    Much like the "sequence" map except that the
                order  of  maps is determined by the service
                switch.  The argument is  the  name  of  the
                service to be looked up; the values from the
                service  switch are appended to the map name
                to create new map names.  For example,  con-
                sider the key definition:

                    Kali switch aliases

                together with the service switch entry:

                    aliases        nis files

                This causes a query against the map "ali" to
                search  maps named "ali.nis" and "ali.files"
                in that order.











SMM:08-140         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      dequote   Strip double quotes (")  from  a  name.   It
                does  not  strip  backslashes,  and will not
                strip quotes if the resulting  string  would
                contain  unscannable  syntax (that is, basic
                errors like unbalanced angle brackets;  more
                sophisticated  errors  such as unknown hosts
                are not checked).  The  intent  is  for  use
                when trying to accept mail from systems such
                as  DECnet  that  routinely quote odd syntax
                such as

                    "49ers::ubell"

                A typical usage is probably something like:

                    Kdequote dequote

                    ...

                    R$-            $: $(dequote $1 $)
                    R$- $+         $: $>3 $1 $2

                Care must be taken to prevent unexpected re-
                sults; for example,

                    "|someprogram < input > output"

                will have quotes stripped, but the result is
                probably not what you had in  mind.   Fortu-
                nately these cases are rare.

      regex     The  map definition on the K line contains a
                regular expression.  Any key input  is  com-
                pared  to  that  expression  using the POSIX
                regular  expressions   routines   regcomp(),
                regerr(), and regexec().  Refer to the docu-
                mentation for those routines for more infor-
                mation  about  the regular expression match-
                ing.  No rewriting of the key is done if the
                -m flag is used.  Without  it,  the  key  is
                discarded  or  if  -s if used, it is substi-
                tuted by the substring matches, delimited by
                $| or the string specified with the  -d  op-
                tion.  The options available for the map are

                    -n  not
                    -f  case sensitive
                    -b  basic regular expressions (default is extended)
                    -s  substring match
                    -d  set the delimiter string used for -s
                    -a  append string to key
                    -m  match only, do not replace/discard value
                    -D  perform no lookup in deferred delivery mode.










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-141


                The  -s option can include an optional para-
                meter which can be used to select  the  sub-
                strings  in  the  result of the lookup.  For
                example,

                    -s1,3,4

                The delimiter string specified  via  the  -d
                option is the sequence of characters after d
                ending  at  the first space.  Hence it isn't
                possible to specify a space as delimiter, so
                if the option is immediately followed  by  a
                space  the  delimiter string is empty, which
                means the substrings are joined.

                Notes: to match a $ in a string, \$$ must be
                used.  If the pattern contains spaces,  they
                must be replaced with the blank substitution
                character, unless it is space itself.

      program   The arguments on the K line are the pathname
                to  a  program and any initial parameters to
                be passed.  When the map is called, the  key
                is  added  to the initial parameters and the
                program is invoked as the default user/group
                id.  The first line of  standard  output  is
                returned  as  the value of the lookup.  This
                has many potential  security  problems,  and
                has  terrible performance; it should be used
                only when absolutely necessary.

      macro     Set or clear a macro value.  To set a macro,
                pass the value as the first argument in  the
                map  lookup.   To clear a macro, do not pass
                an argument in the map lookup.  The map  al-
                ways  returns  the empty string.  Example of
                typical usage include:

                    Kstorage macro

                    ...

                    # set macro ${MyMacro} to the ruleset match
                    R$+ $: $(storage {MyMacro} $@ $1 $) $1
                    # set macro ${MyMacro} to an empty string
                    R$* $: $(storage {MyMacro} $@ $) $1
                    # clear macro ${MyMacro}
                    R$- $: $(storage {MyMacro} $) $1


      arith     Perform simple arithmetic  operations.   The
                operation  is  given as key, currently +, -,
                *, /, %, |, & (bitwise OR, AND), l (for less










SMM:08-142         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                than), =, and r (for random) are  supported.
                The  two  operands  are  given as arguments.
                The lookup returns the result of the  compu-
                tation, i.e., TRUE or FALSE for comparisons,
                integer  values  otherwise.   The r operator
                returns a pseudo-random number  whose  value
                lies  between  the  first and second operand
                (which requires that the  first  operand  is
                smaller than the second).  All options which
                are possible for maps are ignored.  A simple
                example is:

                    Kcomp arith

                    ...

                    Scheck_etrn
                    R$* $: $(comp l $@ $&{load_avg} $@ 7 $) $1
                    RFALSE$# error ...


      socket    The  socket  map uses a simple request/reply
                protocol over TCP or UNIX domain sockets  to
                query an external server.  Both requests and
                replies  are  text based and encoded as net-
                strings, i.e., a string  "hello  there"  be-
                comes:

                    11:hello there,

                Note:  neither requests nor replies end with
                CRLF.

                The request consists  of  the  database  map
                name and the lookup key separated by a space
                character:


                    <mapname> ' ' <key>


                The  server responds with a status indicator
                and the result (if any):


                    <status> ' ' <result>


                The status indicator specifies the result of
                the lookup operation itself and  is  one  of
                the following upper case words:












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-143


                    OK       the key was found, result contains the looked up value
                    NOTFOUND the key was not found, the result is empty
                    TEMP     a temporary failure occurred
                    TIMEOUT  a timeout occurred on the server side
                    PERM     a permanent failure occurred


                In  case  of errors (status TEMP, TIMEOUT or
                PERM) the result field may  contain  an  ex-
                planatory message.  However, the explanatory
                message is not used any further by sendmail.

                Example replies:

                    31:OK resolved.address@example.com,



                    56:OK error:550 5.7.1 User does not accept mail from sender,


                in case of successful lookups, or:

                    8:NOTFOUND,


                in case the key was not found, or:

                    55:TEMP this text explains that we had a temporary failure,


                in case of a temporary map lookup failure.

                The  socket map uses the same syntax as mil-
                ters (see Section "X -- Mail Filter (Milter)
                Definitions") to  specify  the  remote  end-
                point, e.g.,

                    Ksocket mySocketMap inet:12345@127.0.0.1


                If  multiple socket maps define the same re-
                mote endpoint, they will share a single con-
                nection to this endpoint.

           Most of these accept as arguments  the  same  op-
      tional flags and a filename (or a mapname for NIS; the
      filename  is  the  root  of the database path, so that
      ".db" or some  other  extension  appropriate  for  the
      database type will be added to get the actual database
      name).  Known flags are:












SMM:08-144         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      -o        Indicates  that this map is optional -- that
                is, if it cannot be opened, no error is pro-
                duced, and sendmail will behave  as  if  the
                map existed but was empty.

      -N, -O    If  neither -N or -O are specified, sendmail
                uses an adaptive algorithm to decide whether
                or not to look for null bytes on the end  of
                keys.  It starts by trying both; if it finds
                any  key  with  a  null  byte it never tries
                again without a null byte  and  vice  versa.
                If  -N is specified it never tries without a
                null byte and if -O is  specified  it  never
                tries  with  a  null  byte.   Setting one of
                these can speed matches but are never neces-
                sary.  If both  -N  and  -O  are  specified,
                sendmail  will  never try any matches at all
                -- that is, everything will appear to fail.

      -ax       Append the string x on  successful  matches.
                For  example, the default host map appends a
                dot on successful matches.

      -Tx       Append the string x on  temporary  failures.
                For  example,  x  would be appended if a DNS
                lookup returned "server failed"  or  an  NIS
                lookup  could not locate a server.  See also
                the -t flag.

      -f        Do not fold upper to lower case before look-
                ing up the key.

      -m        Match only (without  replacing  the  value).
                If  you  only  care about the existence of a
                key and not the value  (as  you  might  when
                searching the NIS map "hosts.byname" for ex-
                ample), this flag prevents the map from sub-
                stituting  the value.  However, The -a argu-
                ment is still appended on a match,  and  the
                default is still taken if the match fails.

      -kkeycol  The  key  column  name  (for NIS+) or number
                (for text lookups).  For LDAP maps  this  is
                an  LDAP  filter  string  in which %s is re-
                placed with  the  literal  contents  of  the
                lookup  key and %0 is replaced with the LDAP
                escaped contents of the lookup key according
                to RFC 2254.  If the flag -K is  used,  then
                %1 through %9 are replaced with the LDAP es-
                caped contents of the arguments specified in
                the map lookup.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-145


      -vvalcol  The  value  column name (for NIS+) or number
                (for text lookups).  For LDAP maps  this  is
                the name of one or more attributes to be re-
                turned; multiple attributes can be separated
                by commas.  If not specified, all attributes
                found  in  the  match will be returned.  The
                attributes listed can also  include  a  type
                and  one  or  more  objectClass  values  for
                matching as described in the LDAP section.

      -zdelim   The column delimiter (for text lookups).  It
                can be a single character or one of the spe-
                cial strings "\n" or "\t" to  indicate  new-
                line  or  tab  respectively.  If omitted en-
                tirely, the column separator is any sequence
                of white space.  For  LDAP  and  some  other
                maps this is the separator character to com-
                bine  multiple  values  into a single return
                string.  If not set, the  LDAP  lookup  will
                only  return the first match found.  For DNS
                maps this  is  the  separator  character  at
                which the result of a query is cut off if is
                too long.

      -t        Normally, when a map attempts to do a lookup
                and   the   server   fails  (e.g.,  sendmail
                couldn't contact any name  server;  this  is
                not  the same as an entry not being found in
                the map), the  message  being  processed  is
                queued  for  future processing.  The -t flag
                turns off this behavior, letting the  tempo-
                rary  failure (server down) act as though it
                were a permanent failure (entry not  found).
                It  is  particularly useful for DNS lookups,
                where  someone  else's  misconfigured   name
                server  can  cause problems on your machine.
                However, care must be taken to  ensure  that
                you don't bounce mail that would be resolved
                correctly  if  you  tried  again.   A common
                strategy is to forward such mail to another,
                possibly better connected, mail server.

      -D        Perform no lookup in deferred delivery mode.
                This flag is set by  default  for  the  host
                map.

      -Sspacesub
                The  character to use to replace space char-
                acters after a successful map  lookup  (esp.
                useful for regex and syslog maps).

      -sspacesub
                For  the  dequote map only, the character to










SMM:08-146         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                use to replace space characters after a suc-
                cessful dequote.

      -q        Don't dequote the key before lookup.

      -Llevel   For the syslog map only,  it  specifies  the
                level to use for the syslog call.

      -A        When  rebuilding  an alias file, the -A flag
                causes duplicate entries in the text version
                to be merged.  For example, two entries:

                    list:    user1, user2
                    list:    user3

                would be treated as though it were the  sin-
                gle entry

                    list:    user1, user2, user3

                in the presence of the -A flag.

           Some  additional flags are available for the host
      and dns maps:

      -d        delay: specify the resolver's retransmission
                time interval (in seconds).

      -r        retry: specify the number of  times  to  re-
                transmit a resolver query.

           The dns map has another flag:

      -B        basedomain:  specify a domain that is always
                appended to queries.

           Socket maps have an optional flag:

      -d        timeout: specify the  timeout  (in  seconds)
                for   communication   with  the  socket  map
                server.

           The following additional flags are present in the
      ldap map only:

      -ctimeout Set the LDAP network timeout.  sendmail must
                be compiled with  -DLDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT
                to use this flag.

      -R        Do  not auto chase referrals.  sendmail must
                be compiled  with  -DLDAP_REFERRALS  to  use
                this flag.











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-147


      -n        Retrieve attribute names only.

      -Vsep     Retrieve  both attributes name and value(s),
                separated by sep.

      -rderef   Set the alias dereference option to  one  of
                never, always, search, or find.

      -sscope   Set  search  scope  to one of base, one (one
                level), or sub (subtree).

      -hhost    LDAP server hostname.  Some  LDAP  libraries
                allow  you  to specify multiple, space-sepa-
                rated hosts for  redundancy.   In  addition,
                each  of the hosts listed can be followed by
                a colon and a port number  to  override  the
                default LDAP port.

      -pport    LDAP service port.

      -H LDAPURI
                Use the specified LDAP URI instead of speci-
                fying  the hostname and port separately with
                the -h and -p options shown above.  For  ex-
                ample,

                    -h server.example.com -p 389 -b dc=example,dc=com

                is equivalent to

                    -H ldap://server.example.com:389 -b dc=example,dc=com

                If  the  LDAP  library supports it, the LDAP
                URI format however  can  also  request  LDAP
                over   SSL  by  using  ldaps://  instead  of
                ldap://.  For example:

                    O LDAPDefaultSpec=-H ldaps://ldap.example.com -b dc=example,dc=com

                Similarly, if the LDAP library supports  it,
                It can also be used to specify a UNIX domain
                socket using ldapi://:

                    O LDAPDefaultSpec=-H ldapi://socketfile -b dc=example,dc=com


      -bbase    LDAP search base.

      -ltimelimit
                Time limit for LDAP queries.

      -Zsizelimit
                Size  (number  of matches) limit for LDAP or










SMM:08-148         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                DNS queries.

      -ddistinguished_name
                The distinguished name to use  to  login  to
                the LDAP server.

      -Mmethod  The  method  to  authenticate  to  the  LDAP
                server.  Should be  one  of  LDAP_AUTH_NONE,
                LDAP_AUTH_SIMPLE,  or  LDAP_AUTH_KRBV4.  The
                leading LDAP_AUTH_ can be  omitted  and  the
                value is case-insensitive.

      -Ppasswordfile
                The  file  containing the secret key for the
                LDAP_AUTH_SIMPLE  authentication  method  or
                the  name  of  the  Kerberos ticket file for
                LDAP_AUTH_KRBV4.

      -1        Force LDAP searches to  only  succeed  if  a
                single  match  is found.  If multiple values
                are found, the search is treated  as  if  no
                match was found.

      -wversion Set  the  LDAP  API/protocol version to use.
                The default depends on the LDAP  client  li-
                braries  in  use.   For  example,  -w 3 will
                cause sendmail to use LDAPv3  when  communi-
                cating with the LDAP server.

      -K        Treat  the LDAP search key as multi-argument
                and replace %1 through %9 in  the  key  with
                the  LDAP escaped contents of the lookup ar-
                guments specified in the map lookup.

           The dbm map appends the strings ".pag" and ".dir"
      to the given filename; the hash and btree maps  append
      ".db".  For example, the map specification

          Kuucp dbm -o -N /etc/mail/uucpmap

      specifies an optional map named "uucp" of class "dbm";
      it  always  has null bytes at the end of every string,
      and      the      data       is       located       in
      /etc/mail/uucpmap.{dir,pag}.

           The program makemap(8) can be used to build data-
      base-oriented  maps.   It takes at least the following
      flags (for a complete list see its man page):

      -f        Do not fold upper to lower case in the map.

      -N        Include null bytes in keys.











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-149


      -o        Append to an existing (old) file.

      -r        Allow replacement  of  existing  keys;  nor-
                mally,  re-inserting  an  existing key is an
                error.

      -v        Print what is happening.

      The sendmail daemon does not have to be  restarted  to
      read the new maps as long as you change them in place;
      file  locking  is  used so that the maps won't be read
      while they are being updated.

           New classes can be added in the routine setupmaps
      in file conf.c.

   5.11.  Q -- Queue Group Declaration

           In addition to the option  QueueDirectory,  queue
      groups  can be declared that define a (group of) queue
      directories under a common name.   The  syntax  is  as
      follows:

          Qname {, field=value}+

      where name is the symbolic name of the queue group un-
      der  which  it can be referenced in various places and
      the "field=value" pairs define attributes of the queue
      group.  The name must  only  consist  of  alphanumeric
      characters.  Fields are:

      Flags     Flags for this queue group.

      Nice      The  nice(2)  increment for the queue group.
                This value must be greater or equal zero.

      Interval  The time between two queue runs.

      Path      The queue directory of the group (required).

      Runners   The number of  parallel  runners  processing
                the  queue.   Note  that  F=f must be set if
                this value is greater than one.

      Jobs      The maximum number of jobs (messages  deliv-
                ered) per queue run.

      recipients
                The  maximum  number of recipients per enve-
                lope.  Envelopes with more than this  number
                of  recipients  will  be split into multiple
                envelopes in the same queue directory.   The
                default value 0 means no limit.










SMM:08-150         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      Only the first character of the field name is checked.

           By default, a queue group named mqueue is defined
      that  uses  the  value of the QueueDirectory option as
      path.  Notice: all  paths  that  are  used  for  queue
      groups   must  be  subdirectories  of  QueueDirectory.
      Since they can be symbolic links, this  isn't  a  real
      restriction,  If  QueueDirectory uses a wildcard, then
      the directory one level up is considered the  ``base''
      directory  which  all  other  queue  directories  must
      share.  Please make sure that the queue directories do
      not overlap, e.g., do not specify

          O QueueDirectory=/var/spool/mqueue/*
          Qone, P=/var/spool/mqueue/dir1
          Qtwo, P=/var/spool/mqueue/dir2

      because this also includes "dir1" and  "dir2"  in  the
      default queue group.  However,

          O QueueDirectory=/var/spool/mqueue/main*
          Qone, P=/var/spool/mqueue/dir
          Qtwo, P=/var/spool/mqueue/other*

      is a valid queue group specification.

           Options listed in the ``Flags'' field can be used
      to  modify  the  behavior of a queue group.  The ``f''
      flag must be set if multiple queue  runners  are  sup-
      posed to work on the entries in a queue group.  Other-
      wise  sendmail  will  work on the entries strictly se-
      quentially.

           The ``Interval''  field  sets  the  time  between
      queue  runs.   If  no queue group specific interval is
      set, then the parameter of the -q option from the com-
      mand line is used.

           To control the overall number of concurrently ac-
      tive queue runners the option MaxQueueChildren can  be
      set.   This  limits  the  number of processes used for
      running the queues to MaxQueueChildren, though at  any
      one  time fewer processes may be active as a result of
      queue options, completed queue runs, system load, etc.

           The maximum number of queue runners for an  indi-
      vidual  queue  group can be controlled via the Runners
      option.  If set to 0, entries in the queue will not be
      processed, which is  useful  to  ``quarantine''  queue
      files.  The number of runners per queue group may also
      be  set  with the option MaxRunnersPerQueue, which ap-
      plies to queue groups that have no  individual  limit.
      That   is,   the   default   value   for   Runners  is










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-151


      MaxRunnersPerQueue if set, otherwise 1.

           The field Jobs describes the  maximum  number  of
      jobs  (messages delivered) per queue run, which is the
      queue group specific value of MaxQueueRunSize.

           Notice: queue groups should be declared after all
      queue related options  have  been  set  because  queue
      groups  take their defaults from those options.  If an
      option is set after a  queue  group  declaration,  the
      values  of  options  in the queue group are set to the
      defaults of sendmail unless explicitly set in the dec-
      laration.

           Each envelope is assigned to a queue group  based
      on  the  algorithm described in section ``Queue Groups
      and Queue Directories''.

   5.12.  X -- Mail Filter (Milter) Definitions

           The sendmail Mail Filter API (Milter) is designed
      to allow third-party programs access to mail  messages
      as  they  are being processed in order to filter meta-
      information and content.  They  are  declared  in  the
      configuration file as:

          Xname {, field=value}*

      where  name is the name of the filter (used internally
      only) and the "field=name" pairs define attributes  of
      the filter.  Also see the documentation for the Input-
      MailFilters option for more information.

           Fields are:

          Socket    The socket specification
          Flags     Special flags for this filter
          Timeouts  Timeouts for this filter

      Only  the first character of the field name is checked
      (it's case-sensitive).

           The socket specification is one of the  following
      forms:

          S=inet: port @ host


          S=inet6: port @ host


          S=local: path











SMM:08-152         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      The  first two describe an IPv4 or IPv6 socket listen-
      ing on a certain port at a given host or  IP  address.
      The  final  form  describes  a  named  socket  on  the
      filesystem at the given path.

           The following flags may be set in the filter  de-
      scription.

      R   Reject connection if filter unavailable.

      T   Temporary fail connection if filter unavailable.

           If  neither F=R nor F=T is specified, the message
      is passed through sendmail in case of filter errors as
      if the failing filters were not present.

           The timeouts can be set using the four fields in-
      side of the T= equate:

      C   Timeout for connecting to a filter.  If set to  0,
          the system's connect() timeout will be used.

      S   Timeout  for sending information from the MTA to a
          filter.

      R   Timeout for reading reply from the filter.

      E   Overall timeout between sending end-of-message  to
          filter and waiting for the final acknowledgment.

           Note  the separator between each timeout field is
      a  ';'.   The  default  values  (if  not   set)   are:
      T=C:5m;S:10s;R:10s;E:5m  where  s  is seconds and m is
      minutes.

           Examples:

          Xfilter1, S=local:/var/run/f1.sock, F=R
          Xfilter2, S=inet6:999@localhost, F=T, T=S:1s;R:1s;E:5m
          Xfilter3, S=inet:3333@localhost, T=C:2m


   5.13.  The User Database

           The user  database  is  deprecated  in  favor  of
      ``virtusertable''  and  ``genericstable'' as explained
      in the file cf/README.  If you have a version of send-
      mail with the user database package compiled  in,  the
      handling  of  sender  and recipient addresses is modi-
      fied.

           The location of this database is controlled  with
      the UserDatabaseSpec option.










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-153


      5.13.1.  Structure of the user database

              The  database is a sorted (BTree-based) struc-
         ture.  User records are stored with the key:

             user-name:field-name

         The  sorted  database  format  ensures  that   user
         records  are  clustered together.  Meta-information
         is always stored with a leading colon.

              Field names define both the syntax and  seman-
         tics of the value.  Defined fields include:

         maildrop  The   delivery  address  for  this  user.
                   There may  be  multiple  values  of  this
                   record.   In  particular,  mailing  lists
                   will have one maildrop  record  for  each
                   user on the list.

         mailname  The outgoing mailname for this user.  For
                   each  outgoing  name,  there should be an
                   appropriate maildrop record for that name
                   to allow  return  mail.   See  also  :de-
                   fault:mailname.

         mailsender
                   Changes  any mail sent to this address to
                   have the indicated envelope sender.  This
                   is intended for mailing lists,  and  will
                   normally  be  the  name of an appropriate
                   -request address.  It is very similar  to
                   the owner-list syntax in the alias file.

         fullname  The full name of the user.

         office-address
                   The office address for this user.

         office-phone
                   The office phone number for this user.

         office-fax
                   The office FAX number for this user.

         home-address
                   The home address for this user.

         home-phone
                   The home phone number for this user.

         home-fax  The home FAX number for this user.











SMM:08-154         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


         project   A (short) description of the project this
                   person  is  affiliated with.  In the Uni-
                   versity this is often just  the  name  of
                   their graduate advisor.

         plan      A  pointer  to a file from which plan in-
                   formation can be gathered.

              As of this writing, only a few of these fields
         are actually being used by sendmail:  maildrop  and
         mailname.   A  finger  program  that uses the other
         fields is planned.

      5.13.2.  User database semantics

              When the rewriting rules submit an address  to
         the  local  mailer, the user name is passed through
         the alias file.  If no alias is found  (or  if  the
         alias  points  back  to the same address), the name
         (with ":maildrop" appended) is then used as  a  key
         in  the  user  database.  If no match occurs (or if
         the maildrop points at the same address),  forward-
         ing is tried.

              If  the  first token of the user name returned
         by ruleset 0 is an  "@"  sign,  the  user  database
         lookup  is  skipped.   The  intent is that the user
         database will act as a set of defaults for a  clus-
         ter  (in  our case, the Computer Science Division);
         mail sent to a specific machine should ignore these
         defaults.

              When mail is sent, the  name  of  the  sending
         user  is  looked  up in the database.  If that user
         has a "mailname" record, the value of  that  record
         is  used  as  their  outgoing name.  For example, I
         might have a record:

             eric:mailnameEric.Allman@CS.Berkeley.EDU

         This would cause my outgoing mail  to  be  sent  as
         Eric.Allman.

              If  a "maildrop" is found for the user, but no
         corresponding "mailname" record exists, the  record
         ":default:mailname" is consulted.  If present, this
         is  the  name of a host to override the local host.
         For example,  in  our  case  we  would  set  it  to
         "CS.Berkeley.EDU".  The effect is that anyone known
         in the database gets their outgoing mail stamped as
         "user@CS.Berkeley.EDU",  but  people  not listed in
         the database use the local hostname.











Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-155


      5.13.3.  Creating the database[23]

              The user database is built from  a  text  file
         using  the  makemap utility (in the distribution in
         the makemap subdirectory).  The text file is a  se-
         ries of lines corresponding to userdb records; each
         line  has  a  key  and  a  value separated by white
         space.  The key is always in the  format  described
         above -- for example:

             eric:maildrop

         This  file is normally installed in a system direc-
         tory;   for   example,   it   might    be    called
         /etc/mail/userdb.   To make the database version of
         the map, run the program:

             makemap btree /etc/mail/userdb < /etc/mail/userdb

         Then create a config file that uses this.  For  ex-
         ample,  using  the V8 M4 configuration, include the
         following line in your .mc file:

             define(`confUSERDB_SPEC', /etc/mail/userdb)


6.  OTHER CONFIGURATION

        There are some configuration  changes  that  can  be
   made  by  recompiling  sendmail.   This section describes
   what changes can be made and what has to be  modified  to
   make  them.  In most cases this should be unnecessary un-
   less you are porting sendmail to a new environment.

   6.1.  Parameters in devtools/OS/$oscf

           These parameters are  intended  to  describe  the
      compilation  environment,  not site policy, and should
      normally be defined in the operating system configura-
      tion file.  This section needs a complete rewrite.

      NDBM      If set, the new version of the  DBM  library
                that allows multiple databases will be used.
                If  neither  CDB, NDBM, nor NEWDB are set, a
                much less efficient method of  alias  lookup
                is used.
____________________
   [23]These instructions are known to be incomplete.  Other
features are available which provide similar  functionality,
e.g.,  virtual  hosting  and  mapping local addresses into a
generic form as explained in cf/README.












SMM:08-156         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      CDB       If set, use the cdb (tinycdb) package.

      NEWDB     If  set,  use  the new database package from
                Berkeley (from  4.4BSD).   This  package  is
                substantially  faster  than DBM or NDBM.  If
                NEWDB and NDBM are both set,  sendmail  will
                read  DBM  files,  but  will  create and use
                NEWDB files.

      NIS       Include support for NIS.   If  set  together
                with both NEWDB and NDBM, sendmail will cre-
                ate  both DBM and NEWDB files if and only if
                an alias file includes the substring  "/yp/"
                in  the name.  This is intended for compati-
                bility with Sun Microsystems'  mkalias  pro-
                gram used on YP masters.

      NISPLUS   Compile in support for NIS+.

      NETINFO   Compile  in  support  for NetInfo (NeXT sta-
                tions).

      LDAPMAP   Compile in support for  LDAP  X500  queries.
                Requires  libldap and liblber from the Umich
                LDAP 3.2 or 3.3 release  or  equivalent  li-
                braries  for  other  LDAP  libraries such as
                OpenLDAP.

      HESIOD    Compile in support for Hesiod.

      MAP_NSD   Compile in support for IRIX NSD lookups.

      MAP_REGEX Compile in support  for  regular  expression
                matching.

      DNSMAP    Compile  in  support  for DNS map lookups in
                the sendmail.cf file.

      PH_MAP    Compile in support for ph lookups.

      SASL      Compile in support for SASL, a required com-
                ponent for SMTP Authentication support.

      STARTTLS  Compile in support for STARTTLS.

      EGD       Compile in support for the "Entropy  Gather-
                ing  Daemon"  to  provide better random data
                for TLS.

      TCPWRAPPERS
                Compile in support for TCP Wrappers.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-157


      _PATH_SENDMAILCF
                The pathname of the sendmail.cf file.

      _PATH_SENDMAILPID
                The pathname of the sendmail.pid file.

      SM_CONF_SHM
                Compile in support for  shared  memory,  see
                section about "/var/spool/mqueue".

      MILTER    Compile  in  support for contacting external
                mail filters built with the Milter API.

           There are also several compilation flags to indi-
      cate the environment such as "_AIX3" and "_SCO_unix_".
      See the sendmail/README file for the latest  scoop  on
      these flags.

      6.1.1.  For Future Releases

              sendmail  often  contains compile time options
         For Future Releases (prefix _FFR_) which  might  be
         enabled  in a subsequent version or might simply be
         removed as they turned out not to be really useful.
         These features are usually not  documented  but  if
         they  are, then the required (FFR) compile time op-
         tions are listed here for rulesets and macros,  and
         in  cf/README for mc/cf options.  FFR compile times
         options must be enabled when the sendmail binary is
         built from source.  Enabled FFRs in a binary can be
         listed with

             sendmail -d0.13 < /dev/null | grep FFR


   6.2.  Parameters in sendmail/conf.h

           Parameters and compilation options are defined in
      conf.h.  Most of these need not normally  be  tweaked;
      common  parameters  are  all in sendmail.cf.  However,
      the sizes of certain primitive vectors, etc., are  in-
      cluded  in this file.  The numbers following the para-
      meters are their default value.

           This document is not the best source of  informa-
      tion  for  compilation  flags  in  conf.h -- see send-
      mail/README or sendmail/conf.h itself.

      MAXLINE [2048]
                  The maximum line length of any input line.
                  If message lines exceed this  length  they
                  will  still  be  processed correctly; how-
                  ever,  header  lines,  configuration  file










SMM:08-158         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                  lines,  alias lines, etc., must fit within
                  this limit.

      MAXNAME [256]
                  The maximum length of any name, such as  a
                  host or a user name.

      MAXPV [256] The  maximum  number  of parameters to any
                  mailer.  This limits the number of recipi-
                  ents that may be passed  in  one  transac-
                  tion.  It can be set to any arbitrary num-
                  ber  above  about  10, since sendmail will
                  break up a delivery into  smaller  batches
                  as  needed.   A  higher  number may reduce
                  load on your system, however.

      MAXQUEUEGROUPS [50]
                  The maximum number of queue groups.

      MAXATOM [1000]
                  The maximum number of atoms (tokens) in  a
                  single  address.  For example, the address
                  "eric@CS.Berkeley.EDU" is seven atoms.

      MAXMAILERS [25]
                  The maximum number of mailers that may  be
                  defined  in  the configuration file.  This
                  value is defined in include/sendmail/send-
                  mail.h.

      MAXRWSETS [200]
                  The maximum number of rewriting sets  that
                  may  be  defined.  The first half of these
                  are  reserved  for  numeric  specification
                  (e.g.,  ``S92''), while the upper half are
                  reserved   for    auto-numbering    (e.g.,
                  ``Sfoo'').   Thus,  with a value of 200 an
                  attempt to use ``S99'' will  succeed,  but
                  ``S100'' will fail.

      MAXPRIORITIES [25]
                  The  maximum  number  of  values  for  the
                  "Precedence:" field that  may  be  defined
                  (using the P line in sendmail.cf).

      MAXUSERENVIRON [100]
                  The  maximum  number  of items in the user
                  environment that will be passed to  subor-
                  dinate mailers.

      MAXMXHOSTS [100]
                  The  maximum  number of MX records we will
                  accept for any single host.










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-159


      MAXMAPSTACK [12]
                  The maximum number of  maps  that  may  be
                  "stacked" in a sequence class map.

      MAXMIMEARGS [20]
                  The  maximum number of arguments in a MIME
                  Content-Type: header; additional arguments
                  will be ignored.

      MAXMIMENESTING [20]
                  The maximum depth to which  MIME  messages
                  may  be nested (that is, nested Message or
                  Multipart documents; this does  not  limit
                  the  number of components in a single Mul-
                  tipart document).

      MAXDAEMONS [10]
                  The maximum  number  of  sockets  sendmail
                  will  open  for  accepting  connections on
                  different ports.

      MAXMACNAMELEN [25]
                  The maximum length of a macro name.

      A number of other compilation  options  exist.   These
      specify  whether  or  not specific code should be com-
      piled in.  Ones marked with * are 0/1 valued.

      NETINET*    If set, support for Internet protocol net-
                  working is compiled in.  Previous versions
                  of sendmail referred to  this  as  DAEMON;
                  this old usage is now incorrect.  Defaults
                  on;  turn  it  off in the Makefile if your
                  system doesn't support the Internet proto-
                  cols.

      NETINET6*   If set, support  for  IPv6  networking  is
                  compiled  in.   It  must be separately en-
                  abled  by  adding  DaemonPortOptions  set-
                  tings.

      NETISO*     If  set, support for ISO protocol network-
                  ing is compiled in (it may be  appropriate
                  to #define this in the Makefile instead of
                  conf.h).

      NETUNIX*    If set, support for UNIX domain sockets is
                  compiled  in.   This  is  used for control
                  socket support.

      LOG         If set, the syslog routine in use at  some
                  sites  is  used.   This  makes an informa-
                  tional  log  record   for   each   message










SMM:08-160         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


                  processed, and makes a higher priority log
                  record   for   internal   system   errors.
                  STRONGLY RECOMMENDED --  if  you  want  no
                  logging,  turn it off in the configuration
                  file.

      MATCHGECOS* Compile in the code to do  ``fuzzy  match-
                  ing''  on  the GECOS field in /etc/passwd.
                  This also requires that the MatchGECOS op-
                  tion be turned on.

      NAMED_BIND* Compile in code to use the Berkeley Inter-
                  net Name Domain (BIND) server  to  resolve
                  TCP/IP host names.

      NOTUNIX     If  you  are using a non-UNIX mail format,
                  you can set this flag to turn off  special
                  processing of UNIX-style "From " lines.

      USERDB*     Include the experimental Berkeley user in-
                  formation  database  package.  This adds a
                  new level of local name expansion  between
                  aliasing and forwarding.  It also uses the
                  NEWDB  package.  This may change in future
                  releases.

      The following options are normally turned on  in  per-
      operating-system clauses in conf.h.

      IDENTPROTO* Compile  in  the IDENT protocol as defined
                  in RFC 1413.  This  defaults  on  for  all
                  systems  except  Ultrix,  which apparently
                  has the interesting "feature" that when it
                  receives a "host unreachable"  message  it
                  closes  all open connections to that host.
                  Since some firewall gateways send this er-
                  ror code when you access  an  unauthorized
                  port  (such as 113, used by IDENT), Ultrix
                  cannot receive email from such hosts.

      SYSTEM5     Set all of the compilation parameters  ap-
                  propriate for System V.

      HASFLOCK*   Use Berkeley-style flock instead of System
                  V  lockf  to  do file locking.  Due to the
                  highly unusual semantics of  locks  across
                  forks in lockf, this should always be used
                  if at all possible.

      HASINITGROUPS
                  Set  this  if  your  system  has the init-
                  groups() call (if you have multiple  group
                  support).   This is the default if SYSTEM5










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-161


                  is not defined or if you are on HPUX.

      HASUNAME    Set this if you have the  uname(2)  system
                  call  (or  corresponding library routine).
                  Set by default if SYSTEM5 is set.

      HASGETDTABLESIZE
                  Set this if you have the  getdtablesize(2)
                  system call.

      HASWAITPID  Set  this  if  you  have the haswaitpid(2)
                  system call.

      FAST_PID_RECYCLE
                  Set this if your system can possibly reuse
                  the same pid in the same second of time.

      SFS_TYPE    The mechanism that can be used to get file
                  system capacity information.   The  values
                  can  be one of SFS_USTAT (use the ustat(2)
                  syscall), SFS_4ARGS (use the four argument
                  statfs(2) syscall), SFS_VFS (use  the  two
                  argument   statfs(2)   syscall   including
                  <sys/vfs.h>), SFS_MOUNT (use the two argu-
                  ment    statfs(2)    syscall     including
                  <sys/mount.h>),  SFS_STATFS  (use  the two
                  argument   statfs(2)   syscall   including
                  <sys/statfs.h>),  SFS_STATVFS (use the two
                  argument   statfs(2)   syscall   including
                  <sys/statvfs.h>),  or  SFS_NONE (no way to
                  get this information).

      LA_TYPE     The load average type.   Details  are  de-
                  scribed below.

      The  are  several  built-in ways of computing the load
      average.  Sendmail tries to auto-configure them  based
      on  imperfect guesses; you can select one using the cc
      option -DLA_TYPE=type, where type is:

      LA_INT      The kernel stores the load average in  the
                  kernel  as an array of long integers.  The
                  actual values are scaled by a  factor  FS-
                  CALE (default 256).

      LA_SHORT    The  kernel stores the load average in the
                  kernel as an array of short integers.  The
                  actual values are scaled by a  factor  FS-
                  CALE (default 256).

      LA_FLOAT    The  kernel stores the load average in the
                  kernel as an  array  of  double  precision
                  floats.










SMM:08-162         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      LA_MACH     Use MACH-style load averages.

      LA_SUBR     Call  the  getloadavg  routine  to get the
                  load average as an array of doubles.

      LA_ZERO     Always return zero as  the  load  average.
                  This is the fallback case.

      If  type  LA_INT,  LA_SHORT, or LA_FLOAT is specified,
      you may also need to specify _PATH_UNIX (the  path  to
      your  system  binary)  and LA_AVENRUN (the name of the
      variable containing the load average  in  the  kernel;
      usually "_avenrun" or "avenrun").

   6.3.  Configuration in sendmail/conf.c

           The following changes can be made in conf.c.

      6.3.1.  Built-in Header Semantics

              Not  all  header  semantics are defined in the
         configuration file.  Header lines that should  only
         be  included  by  certain mailers (as well as other
         more obscure semantics) must be  specified  in  the
         HdrInfo  table  in conf.c.  This table contains the
         header name (which should be in all lower case) and
         a set of header control  flags  (described  below),
         The flags are:

         H_ACHECK    Normally  when the check is made to see
                     if a header line is compatible  with  a
                     mailer, sendmail will not delete an ex-
                     isting  line.   If  this  flag  is set,
                     sendmail  will  delete  even   existing
                     header  lines.  That is, if this bit is
                     set and the mailer does not  have  flag
                     bits  set  that  intersect with the re-
                     quired mailer flags in the header defi-
                     nition in sendmail.cf, the header  line
                     is always deleted.

         H_EOH       If  this  header field is set, treat it
                     like a blank line, i.e., it will signal
                     the end of the header and the beginning
                     of the message text.

         H_FORCE     Add this header entry even if  one  ex-
                     isted  in  the  message  before.   If a
                     header entry does  not  have  this  bit
                     set,  sendmail  will  not  add  another
                     header line if a header  line  of  this
                     name  already existed.  This would nor-
                     mally be used to stamp the  message  by










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-163


                     everyone who handled it.

         H_TRACE     If  set,  this  is  a timestamp (trace)
                     field.  If the number of  trace  fields
                     in  a  message  exceeds a preset amount
                     the message is returned on the  assump-
                     tion that it has an aliasing loop.

         H_RCPT      If  set,  this field contains recipient
                     addresses.  This is used by the -t flag
                     to determine who to send to when it  is
                     collecting recipients from the message.

         H_FROM      This  flag  indicates  that  this field
                     specifies a sender.  The order of these
                     fields in the HdrInfo  table  specifies
                     sendmail's  preference  for which field
                     to return error messages to.

         H_ERRORSTO  Addresses in this header should receive
                     error messages.

         H_CTE       This header is  a  Content-Transfer-En-
                     coding header.

         H_CTYPE     This header is a Content-Type header.

         H_BCC       Strip  the  value  from the header (for
                     Bcc:).

         Let's look at a sample HdrInfo specification:
































SMM:08-164         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


             struct hdrinfo                    HdrInfo[] =
             {
                      /* originator fields, most to least significant  */
                 "resent-sender",              H_FROM,
                 "resent-from",                H_FROM,
                 "sender",                     H_FROM,
                 "from",                       H_FROM,
                 "full-name",                  H_ACHECK,
                 "errors-to",                  H_FROM|H_ERRORSTO,
                      /* destination fields */
                 "to",                         H_RCPT,
                 "resent-to",                  H_RCPT,
                 "cc",                         H_RCPT,
                 "bcc",                        H_RCPT|H_BCC,
                      /* message identification and control */
                 "message",                    H_EOH,
                 "text",                       H_EOH,
                      /* trace fields */
                 "received",                   H_TRACE|H_FORCE,
                      /* miscellaneous fields */
                 "content-transfer-encoding",  H_CTE,
                 "content-type",               H_CTYPE,

                 NULL,                         0,
             };

         This structure indicates that the  "To:",  "Resent-
         To:",  and  "Cc:"  fields all specify recipient ad-
         dresses.  Any "Full-Name:" field  will  be  deleted
         unless  the  required mailer flag (indicated in the
         configuration file) is specified.   The  "Message:"
         and "Text:" fields will terminate the header; these
         are  used  by  random dissenters around the network
         world.  The "Received:" field will always be added,
         and can be used to trace messages.

              There are a number of important  points  here.
         First,  header  fields  are not added automatically
         just because they are  in  the  HdrInfo  structure;
         they must be specified in the configuration file in
         order  to  be  added  to  the  message.  Any header
         fields mentioned in the configuration file but  not
         mentioned  in  the  HdrInfo  structure have default
         processing performed; that is, they are  added  un-
         less they were in the message already.  Second, the
         HdrInfo  structure  only specifies cliched process-
         ing; certain headers are processed specially by  ad
         hoc  code  regardless  of  the  status specified in
         HdrInfo.  For example, the  "Sender:"  and  "From:"
         fields are always scanned on ARPANET mail to deter-













Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-165


         mine  the  sender[24];  this is used to perform the
         "return  to  sender"  function.   The  "From:"  and
         "Full-Name:"  fields are used to determine the full
         name of the sender if possible; this is  stored  in
         the macro $x and used in a number of ways.

      6.3.2.  Restricting Use of Email

              If  it is necessary to restrict mail through a
         relay, the checkcompat  routine  can  be  modified.
         This routine is called for every recipient address.
         It  returns an exit status indicating the status of
         the message.  The status EX_OK accepts the address,
         EX_TEMPFAIL queues the message for a later try, and
         other values (commonly EX_UNAVAILABLE)  reject  the
         message.  It is up to checkcompat to print an error
         message  (using usrerr) if the message is rejected.
         For example, checkcompat could read:

             int
             checkcompat(to, e)
                 register ADDRESS *to;
                 register ENVELOPE *e;
             {
                 register STAB *s;

                 s = stab("private", ST_MAILER, ST_FIND);
                 if (s != NULL && e->e_from.q_mailer != LocalMailer &&
                     to->q_mailer == s->s_mailer)
                 {
                     usrerr("No private net mail allowed through this machine");
                     return (EX_UNAVAILABLE);
                 }
                 if (MsgSize > 50000 && bitnset(M_LOCALMAILER, to->q_mailer))
                 {
                     usrerr("Message too large for non-local delivery");
                     e->e_flags |= EF_NORETURN;
                     return (EX_UNAVAILABLE);
                 }
                 return (EX_OK);
             }

         This would reject messages greater than 50000 bytes
         unless they were local.  The EF_NORETURN  flag  can
         be  set in e->e_flags to suppress the return of the
         actual body of the message  in  the  error  return.
         The  actual use of this routine is highly dependent
         on the implementation, and use should be limited.
____________________
   [24]Actually, this is no longer true in SMTP; this infor-
mation is contained in the envelope.  The older ARPANET pro-
tocols did not completely distinguish envelope from header.











SMM:08-166         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


      6.3.3.  New Database Map Classes

              New key maps can be added by creating a  class
         initialization  function  and  a  lookup  function.
         These are then added to the routine setupmaps.

              The initialization function is called as

             xxx_map_init(MAP *map, char *args)

         The map is an internal data structure.  The args is
         a pointer to the portion of the configuration  file
         line  following the map class name; flags and file-
         names can be extracted from this  line.   The  ini-
         tialization  function  must  return true if it suc-
         cessfully opened the map, false otherwise.

              The lookup function is called as

             xxx_map_lookup(MAP *map, char buf[], char **av, int *statp)

         The map defines the map internally.   The  buf  has
         the input key.  This may be (and often is) used de-
         structively.   The av is a list of arguments passed
         in from the  rewrite  line.   The  lookup  function
         should  return  a pointer to the new value.  If the
         map lookup fails, *statp should be set to  an  exit
         status  code;  in  particular,  it should be set to
         EX_TEMPFAIL if recovery is to be attempted  by  the
         higher level code.

      6.3.4.  Queueing Function

              The routine shouldqueue is called to decide if
         a  message  should  be  queued or processed immedi-
         ately.  Typically this compares the message  prior-
         ity to the current load average.  The default defi-
         nition is:

             bool
             shouldqueue(pri, ctime)
                 long pri;
                 time_t ctime;
             {
                 if (CurrentLA < QueueLA)
                     return false;
                 return (pri > (QueueFactor / (CurrentLA - QueueLA + 1)));
             }

         If  the  current load average (global variable Cur-
         rentLA,  which  is  set  before  this  function  is
         called) is less than the low threshold load average
         (option  x,  variable QueueLA), shouldqueue returns










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-167


         false immediately (that is, it should  not  queue).
         If  the  current  load  average  exceeds  the  high
         threshold load  average  (option  X,  variable  Re-
         fuseLA),   shouldqueue  returns  true  immediately.
         Otherwise, it computes the function  based  on  the
         message  priority,  the  queue  factor  (option  q,
         global variable QueueFactor), and the  current  and
         threshold load averages.

              An  implementation  wishing to take the actual
         age of the message into account can  also  use  the
         ctime parameter, which is the time that the message
         was first submitted to sendmail.  Note that the pri
         parameter  is  already  weighted  by  the number of
         times the message has  been  tried  (although  this
         tends  to  lower  the  priority of the message with
         time); the expectation is that the ctime  would  be
         used  as an "escape clause" to ensure that messages
         are eventually processed.

      6.3.5.  Refusing Incoming SMTP Connections

              The function refuseconnections returns true if
         incoming SMTP connections should be  refused.   The
         current  implementation is based exclusively on the
         current load average and the  refuse  load  average
         option (option X, global variable RefuseLA):

             bool
             refuseconnections()
             {
                 return (RefuseLA > 0 && CurrentLA >= RefuseLA);
             }

         A  more  clever  implementation  could look at more
         system resources.

      6.3.6.  Load Average Computation

              The routine getla returns the current load av-
         erage (as a rounded integer).  The distribution in-
         cludes several possible  implementations.   If  you
         are  porting  to  a new environment you may need to
         add some new tweaks.[25]




____________________
   [25]If you do,  please  send  updates  to  sendmail@Send-
mail.ORG.












SMM:08-168         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


   6.4.  Configuration in sendmail/daemon.c

           The  file  sendmail/daemon.c contains a number of
      routines that are dependent on  the  local  networking
      environment.   The  version  supplied assumes you have
      BSD style sockets.

           In previous releases,  we  recommended  that  you
      modify the routine maphostname if you wanted to gener-
      alize  $[  ...  $] lookups.  We now recommend that you
      create a new keyed map instead.

   6.5.  LDAP

           In this section we assume that sendmail has  been
      compiled with support for LDAP.

      6.5.1.  LDAP Recursion

              LDAP  Recursion allows you to add types to the
         search attributes on  an  LDAP  map  specification.
         The syntax is:

         -v ATTRIBUTE[:TYPE[:OBJECTCLASS[|OBJECTCLASS|...]]]


              The new TYPEs are:

         NORMAL    This  attribute  type  specifies  the at-
                   tribute to add  to  the  results  string.
                   This is the default.

         DN        Any  matches  for  this attribute are ex-
                   pected to have a value of a fully  quali-
                   fied  distinguished  name.  sendmail will
                   lookup that DN and apply  the  attributes
                   requested to the returned DN record.

         FILTER    Any  matches  for  this attribute are ex-
                   pected to have a value of an LDAP  search
                   filter.   sendmail  will perform a lookup
                   with the same parameters as the  original
                   search  but  replaces  the  search filter
                   with the one specified here.

         URL       Any matches for this  attribute  are  ex-
                   pected  to  have  a value of an LDAP URL.
                   sendmail will perform a  lookup  of  that
                   URL  and use the results from the attrib-
                   utes named in  that  URL.   Note  however
                   that the search is done using the current
                   LDAP  connection,  regardless  of what is
                   specified as the scheme, LDAP  host,  and










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-169


                   LDAP port in the LDAP URL.

         Any  untyped  attributes  are considered NORMAL at-
         tributes as described above.

              The optional OBJECTCLASS  (|  separated)  list
         contains  the objectClass values for which that at-
         tribute applies.  If the list  is  given,  the  at-
         tribute  named will only be used if the LDAP record
         being returned is a member of  that  object  class.
         Note  that  if  these new value attribute TYPEs are
         used in an AliasFile option setting, it  will  need
         to  be  double quoted to prevent sendmail from mis-
         parsing the colons.

              Note that LDAP recursion attributes  which  do
         not ultimately point to an LDAP record are not con-
         sidered an error.

         6.5.1.1.  Example

                 Since  examples  usually help clarify, here
            is an example which uses all  four  of  the  new
            types:

                O LDAPDefaultSpec=-h ldap.example.com -b dc=example,dc=com

                Kexample ldap
                         -z,
                         -k (&(objectClass=sendmailMTAAliasObject)(sendmailMTAKey=%0))
                         -v sendmailMTAAliasValue,mail:NORMAL:inetOrgPerson,
                            uniqueMember:DN:groupOfUniqueNames,
                            sendmailMTAAliasSearch:FILTER:sendmailMTAAliasObject,
                            sendmailMTAAliasURL:URL:sendmailMTAAliasObject


                 That definition specifies that:

             + Any  value  in  a  sendmailMTAAliasValue  at-
               tribute will be added to  the  result  string
               regardless of object class.
             + The  mail  attribute will be added to the re-
               sult string if the LDAP record is a member of
               the inetOrgPerson object class.
             + The uniqueMember attribute is a recursive at-
               tribute,  used  only  in   groupOfUniqueNames
               records, and should contain an LDAP DN point-
               ing  to another LDAP record.  The desire here
               is to return the mail  attribute  from  those
               DNs.
             + The   sendmailMTAAliasSearch   attribute  and
               sendmailMTAAliasURL are  both  used  only  if
               referenced in a sendmailMTAAliasObject.  They










SMM:08-170         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


               are  both recursive, the first for a new LDAP
               search string and the latter for an LDAP URL.

   6.6.  STARTTLS

           In this section we assume that sendmail has  been
      compiled  with  support for STARTTLS.  To properly un-
      derstand the use of STARTTLS in sendmail, it is neces-
      sary to understand at least some  basics  about  X.509
      certificates and public key cryptography.  This infor-
      mation  can  be found in books about SSL/TLS or on WWW
      sites, e.g., "https://www.OpenSSL.org/".

      6.6.1.  Certificates for STARTTLS

              When acting as  a  server,  sendmail  requires
         X.509 certificates to support STARTTLS: one as cer-
         tificate  for the server (ServerCertFile and corre-
         sponding private ServerKeyFile) at least  one  root
         CA  (CACertFile),  i.e., a certificate that is used
         to sign other certificates, and a path to a  direc-
         tory  which contains (zero or more) other CAs (CAC-
         ertPath).  The file specified  via  CACertFile  can
         contain  several  certificates  of CAs.  The DNs of
         these certificates are sent to  the  client  during
         the   TLS   handshake  (as  part  of  the  Certifi-
         cateRequest) as the list of acceptable  CAs.   How-
         ever,  do  not list too many root CAs in that file,
         otherwise the TLS handshake may fail; e.g.,

             error:14094417:SSL routines:SSL3_READ_BYTES:
             sslv3 alert illegal parameter:s3_pkt.c:964:SSL alert number 47

         You should probably put only the CA cert into  that
         file that signed your own cert(s), or at least only
         those  you  trust.   The  CACertPath directory must
         contain the hashes of each CA certificate as  file-
         names (or as links to them).  Symbolic links can be
         generated  with  the  following  two (Bourne) shell
         commands:

             C=FileName_of_CA_Certificate
             ln -s $C `openssl x509 -noout -hash < $C`.0

         A better way to do this is to use the c_rehash com-
         mand that is part of the OpenSSL  distribution  be-
         cause  it handles subject hash collisions by incre-
         menting the number in the suffix of the filename of
         the symbolic link, e.g., .0 to .1, and so  on.   An
         X.509  certificate is also required for authentica-
         tion in client mode (ClientCertFile and correspond-
         ing private ClientKeyFile), however, sendmail  will
         always  use STARTTLS when offered by a server.  The










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-171


         client and server certificates  can  be  identical.
         Certificates can be obtained from a certificate au-
         thority  or  created with the help of OpenSSL.  The
         required format for certificates and  private  keys
         is  PEM.   To  allow for automatic startup of send-
         mail, private keys  (ServerKeyFile,  ClientKeyFile)
         must be stored unencrypted.  The keys are only pro-
         tected  by  the  permissions  of  the  file system.
         Never make a  private  key  available  to  a  third
         party.

              The   options  ClientCertFile,  ClientKeyFile,
         ServerCertFile, and ServerKeyFile can take a second
         file name, which must be separated from  the  first
         with  a  comma (note: do not use any spaces) to set
         up a second cert/key pair.  This  can  be  used  to
         have certs of different types, e.g., RSA and DSA.

      6.6.2.  PRNG for STARTTLS

              STARTTLS  requires a strong pseudo random num-
         ber generator (PRNG) to operate properly.   Depend-
         ing  on the TLS library you use, it may be required
         to explicitly initialize the PRNG with random data.
         OpenSSL makes use of /dev/urandom(4)  if  available
         (this  corresponds  to  the  compile  flag HASURAN-
         DOMDEV).  On systems which  lack  this  support,  a
         random  file  must  be specified in the sendmail.cf
         file using the option RandFile.  It is strongly ad-
         vised to use the  "Entropy  Gathering  Daemon"  EGD
         from  Brian Warner on those systems to provide use-
         ful random data.  In this case,  sendmail  must  be
         compiled with the flag EGD, and the RandFile option
         must   point   to   the  EGD  socket.   If  neither
         /dev/urandom(4) nor EGD are available, you have  to
         make  sure that useful random data is available all
         the time in RandFile.  If the file hasn't been mod-
         ified in the last 10 minutes before it is  supposed
         to  be  used  by sendmail the content is considered
         obsolete.  One method for generating this file is:

             openssl rand -out /etc/mail/randfile -rand /path/to/file:...256

         See the OpenSSL documentation for more information.
         In this case, the PRNG for TLS is only seeded  with
         other  random  data if the DontBlameSendmail option
         InsufficientEntropy is set.  This  is  most  likely
         not  sufficient  for certain actions, e.g., genera-
         tion of (temporary) keys.

              Please see the OpenSSL documentation or  other
         sources for further information about certificates,
         their creation and their usage, the importance of a










SMM:08-172         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


         good PRNG, and other aspects of TLS.

   6.7.  Encoding of STARTTLS and AUTH related Macros

           Macros  that  contain  STARTTLS  and AUTH related
      data which  comes  from  outside  sources,  e.g.,  all
      macros  containing  information from certificates, are
      encoded to avoid problems with non-printable  or  spe-
      cial  characters.   The latter are '\', '<', '>', '(',
      ')', '"', '+', and ' '.  All of these  characters  are
      replaced  by their value in hexadecimal with a leading
      '+'.  For example:

          /C=US/ST=California/O=endmail.org/OU=private/CN=Darth Mail (Cert)/
          Email=darth+cert@endmail.org

      is encoded as:

          /C=US/ST=California/O=endmail.org/OU=private/
          CN=Darth+20Mail+20+28Cert+29/Email=darth+2Bcert@endmail.org

      (line breaks have been inserted for readability).  The
      macros  which  are  subject  to  this   encoding   are
      {cert_subject},  {cert_issuer},  {cn_subject}, {cn_is-
      suer}, as well as {auth_authen} and {auth_author}.

   6.8.  DANE

           Support for DANE (see RFC 7672 et.al.)  is avail-
      able if sendmail is compiled with the option DANE.  If
      OpenSSL 1.1.1 or at least 3.0.0 are  used,  then  full
      DANE  support  for DANE-EE and DANE-TA (as required by
      RFC 7672) is available via the functions  provided  by
      those OpenSSL versions (run

          sendmail -bt -d0.3 < /dev/null

      and check that HAVE_SSL_CTX_dane_enable is in the out-
      put),  otherwise  support  for TLSA RR 3-1-x is imple-
      mented directly in sendmail.  Note: if  OpenSSL  func-
      tions  related to DANE cause a failure, then the macro
      ${verify} is set to DANE_TEMP.  This also  applies  if
      TLS cannot be initialized at all.  The option

          O DANE=true

      enables  this feature at run time and it automatically
      adds use_dnssec and use_edns0 to

          O ResolverOptions

      This requires a DNSSEC-validating  recursive  resolver
      which  supports  those  options.  The resolver must be










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-173


      reachable via a trusted connection, hence it  is  best
      to run it locally.

      If  the  client  finds  a usable TLSA RR and the check
      succeeds the macro ${verify} is set to  TRUSTED.   All
      non-DNS  maps  are  considered  secure  just  like DNS
      lookups with DNSSEC.  Be aware that TLSA RRs  are  not
      looked up for some features, e.g., FallBackSmartHost.

   6.9.  EAI

           Experimental  support  for SMTPUTF8 (EAI, see RFC
      6530-6533) is available when the compile  time  option
      USE_EAI, (see also devtools/Site/site.config.m4.sample
      for  other  settings that might be needed), and the cf
      option SMTPUTF8 are used.   This  allows  the  use  of
      UTF-8  for  envelope  addresses  as well as the entire
      message.  DNS lookups are done using the A-label  for-
      mat (Punycode) as required by the RFCs.  For all other
      interactions  with external programs and maps, the ac-
      tual value are  used,  i.e.,  no  conversions  between
      UTF-8  and  ASCII encodings are made.  This applies to
      the keys in map lookups, which might require to  spec-
      ify  both versions in a map; the data exchanged with a
      milter, i.e., each milter must be "8 bit clean";  mail
      delivery agents which must be able to handle 8 bit ad-
      dresses.   Some values must be ASCII as those are used
      before SMTPUTF8 support can be  requested,  e.g.,  the
      macros $j and $m.  Please test and provide feedback.

   6.10.  MTA-STS

           Experimental  support  for SMTP MTA Strict Trans-
      port Security (MTA-STS, see  RFC  8461)  is  available
      when  using  the  compile time option _FFR_MTA_STS (as
      well as some others, e.g., _FFR_TLS_ALTNAMES and obvi-
      ously STARTTLS), FEATURE(sts) (which  implicitly  sets
      the  cf  option StrictTransportSecurity), and postfix-
      mta-sts-resolver (see https://github.com/Snawoot/post-
      fix-mta-sts-resolver.git).

           Note: this implementation uses a  socket  map  to
      communicate  with postfix-mta-sts-resolver and handles
      only the values returned by that program, which  might
      not fully implement MTA-STS.

           If  both  DANE and MTA-STS are enabled and avail-
      able for the receiving domain, DANE is used because it
      offers a much higher level of security.














SMM:08-174         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


7.  ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS

        I've worked on sendmail for many years, and many em-
   ployers have been remarkably  patient  about  letting  me
   work  on a large project that was not part of my official
   job.  This includes time on the  INGRES  Project  at  the
   University of California at Berkeley, at Britton Lee, and
   again on the Mammoth and Titan Projects at Berkeley.

        Much of the second wave of improvements resulting in
   version  8.1  should be credited to Bryan Costales of the
   International Computer Science Institute.  As  he  passed
   me drafts of his book on sendmail I was inspired to start
   working  on  things  again.   Bryan was also available to
   bounce ideas off of.

        Gregory Neil Shapiro of Worcester Polytechnic Insti-
   tute has become instrumental in all  phases  of  sendmail
   support  and development, and was largely responsible for
   getting versions 8.8 and 8.9 out the door.

        Many, many people contributed  chunks  of  code  and
   ideas  to  sendmail.  It has proven to be a group network
   effort.  Version 8 in particular  was  a  group  project.
   The  following people and organizations made notable con-
   tributions:

       Claus Assmann
       John Beck, Hewlett-Packard & Sun Microsystems
       Keith Bostic, CSRG, University of California, Berkeley
       Andrew Cheng, Sun Microsystems
       Michael J. Corrigan, University of California, San Diego
       Bryan Costales, International Computer Science Institute & InfoBeat
       Par (Pell) Emanuelsson
       Craig Everhart, Transarc Corporation
       Per Hedeland, Ericsson
       Tom Ivar Helbekkmo, Norwegian School of Economics
       Kari Hurtta, Finnish Meteorological Institute
       Allan E. Johannesen, WPI
       Jonathan Kamens, OpenVision Technologies, Inc.
       Takahiro Kanbe, Fuji Xerox Information Systems Co., Ltd.
       Brian Kantor, University of California, San Diego
       John Kennedy, Cal State University, Chico
       Murray S. Kucherawy, HookUp Communication Corp.
       Bruce Lilly, Sony U.S.
       Karl London
       Motonori Nakamura, Ritsumeikan University & Kyoto University
       John Gardiner Myers, Carnegie Mellon University
       Neil Rickert, Northern Illinois University
       Gregory Neil Shapiro, WPI
       Eric Schnoebelen, Convex Computer Corp.
       Eric Wassenaar, National Institute for Nuclear and High Energy Physics, Amsterdam
       Randall Winchester, University of Maryland










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-175


       Christophe Wolfhugel, Pasteur Institute & Herve Schauer Consultants (Paris)
       Exactis.com, Inc.

   I apologize for anyone I have omitted, misspelled, misat-
   tributed, or otherwise missed.  At this point, I  suspect
   that at least a hundred people have contributed code, and
   many  more  have contributed ideas, comments, and encour-
   agement.  I've tried to list them in the RELEASE_NOTES in
   the distribution directory.  I appreciate their contribu-
   tion as well.

        Special thanks are reserved for Michael Corrigan and
   Christophe Wolfhugel, who besides being wonderful  guinea
   pigs  and contributors have also consented to be added to
   the ``sendmail@Sendmail.ORG'' list and, by answering  the
   bulk of the questions sent to that list, have freed me up
   to do other work.

















































                          Appendix A


                      COMMAND LINE FLAGS




     Arguments  must  be  presented  with  flags  before ad-
dresses.  The flags are:

-Ax       Select an alternative .cf  file  which  is  either
          sendmail.cf  for -Am or submit.cf for -Ac.  By de-
          fault the .cf file is chosen based on  the  opera-
          tion  mode.   For -bm (default), -bs, and -t it is
          submit.cf if it exists, for all others it is send-
          mail.cf.

-bx       Set operation mode to x.  Operation modes are:

              m   Deliver mail (default)
              s   Speak SMTP on input side
              a*  ``Arpanet'' mode (get envelope sender information from header)
              C   Check the configuration file
              d   Run as a daemon in background
              D   Run as a daemon in foreground
              t   Run in test mode
              v   Just verify addresses, don't collect or deliver
              i   Initialize the alias database
              p   Print the mail queue
              P   Print overview over the mail queue (requires shared memory)
              h   Print the persistent host status database
              H   Purge expired entries from the persistent host status database


-Btype    Indicate body type.

-Cfile    Use a different configuration file.  Sendmail runs
          as the invoking user (rather than root) when  this
          flag is specified.

-D logfile
          Send debugging output to the indicated logfile in-
          stead of stdout.

-dlevel   Set debugging level.

-f addr   The  envelope sender address is set to addr.  This
          address may also be used in the  From:  header  if
____________________
   *Deprecated.




SMM:08-176         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide







Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-177


          that  header is missing during initial submission.
          The envelope sender address is used as the recipi-
          ent for delivery status notifications and may also
          appear in a Return-Path: header.

-F name   Sets the full name of this user to name.

-G        When accepting messages via the command line,  in-
          dicate  that  they are for relay (gateway) submis-
          sion.  sendmail may complain  about  syntactically
          invalid  messages,  e.g.,  unqualified host names,
          rather than fixing them when  this  flag  is  set.
          sendmail  will not do any canonicalization in this
          mode.

-h cnt    Sets the "hop count" to cnt.  This represents  the
          number of times this message has been processed by
          sendmail  (to  the  extent that it is supported by
          the underlying networks).  Cnt is incremented dur-
          ing processing, and if  it  reaches  MAXHOP  (cur-
          rently  25)  sendmail throws away the message with
          an error.

-L tag    Sets the identifier used for  syslog.   Note  that
          this identifier is set as early as possible.  How-
          ever,  sendmail  may be used if problems arise be-
          fore the command line arguments are processed.

-n        Don't do aliasing or forwarding.

-N notifications
          Tag all addresses being sent as wanting the  indi-
          cated  notifications,  which  consists of the word
          "NEVER" or a comma-separated  list  of  "SUCCESS",
          "FAILURE",  and  "DELAY"  for successful delivery,
          failure, and a message that is stuck  in  a  queue
          somewhere.  The default is "FAILURE,DELAY".

-r addr   An obsolete form of -f.

-oxvalue  Set  option  x  to the specified value.  These op-
          tions are described in Section 5.6.

-Ooption=value
          Set option to the specified value (for  long  form
          option  names).   These  options  are described in
          Section 5.6.

-Mxvalue  Set macro x to the specified value.

-pprotocol
          Set the sending protocol.  Programs are encouraged
          to set this.  The protocol field  can  be  in  the










SMM:08-178         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


          form  protocol:host to set both the sending proto-
          col and sending host.  For example, "-pUUCP:uunet"
          sets the sending protocol to UUCP and the  sending
          host to uunet.  (Some existing programs use -oM to
          set  the r and s macros; this is equivalent to us-
          ing -p.)

-qtime    Try to process the queued up mail.  If the time is
          given, sendmail will start one or  more  processes
          to  run through the queue(s) at the specified time
          interval to deliver  queued  mail;  otherwise,  it
          only runs once.  Each of these processes acts on a
          workgroup.   These  processes  are  also  known as
          workgroup processes  or  WGP's  for  short.   Each
          workgroup  is responsible for controlling the pro-
          cessing of one or  more  queues;  workgroups  help
          manage  the  use  of system resources by sendmail.
          Each workgroup may have one or more children  con-
          currently  processing queues depending on the set-
          ting of MaxQueueChildren.

-qptime   Similar to -q with a time  argument,  except  that
          instead  of  periodically  starting WGP's sendmail
          starts persistent  WGP's  that  alternate  between
          processing queues and sleeping.  The sleep time is
          specified  by  the time argument; it defaults to 1
          second, except that a WGP always sleeps at least 5
          seconds if their queues were empty in the previous
          run.  Persistent processes are managed by a  queue
          control  process  (QCP).   The  QCP  is the parent
          process of the WGP's.  Typically the QCP  will  be
          the sendmail daemon (when started with -bd or -bD)
          or  a  special process (named Queue control) (when
          started without -bd or -bD).  If a persistent  WGP
          ceases  to  be  active for some reason another WGP
          will be started by the QCP for the same  workgroup
          in  most  cases.  When  a  persistent WGP has core
          dumped, the debug  flag  no_persistent_restart  is
          set  or  the  specific  persistent  WGP  has  been
          restarted too many times already then the WGP will
          not be started again and a message will be  logged
          to  this  effect.   To  stop  (SIGTERM) or restart
          (SIGHUP) persistent WGP's the  appropriate  signal
          should  be sent to the QCP. The QCP will propagate
          the signal to all of the WGP's and if  appropriate
          restart the persistent WGP's.

-qGname   Run the jobs in the queue group name once.

-q[!]Xstring
          Run  the  queue  once,  limiting the jobs to those
          matching Xstring.  The key letter X can  be  I  to
          limit  based on queue identifier, R to limit based










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-179


          on recipient, S to limit based on sender, or Q  to
          limit  based  on quarantine reason for quarantined
          jobs.  A particular queued job is accepted if  one
          of the corresponding attributes contains the indi-
          cated  string.   The  optional ! character negates
          the condition tested.  Multiple -qX flags are per-
          mitted,  with  items  with  the  same  key  letter
          "or'ed"  together,  and  items  with different key
          letters "and'ed" together.

-Q[reason]
          Quarantine normal queue items with the given  rea-
          son  or unquarantine quarantined queue items if no
          reason is given.  This should only  be  used  with
          some  sort  of item matching using -q[!]Xstring as
          described above.

-R ret    What information you want returned if the  message
          bounces;  ret  can  be  "HDRS" for headers only or
          "FULL" for headers plus body.  This is  a  request
          only;  the  other end is not required to honor the
          parameter.  If "HDRS" is specified  local  bounces
          also return only the headers.

-t        Read  the  header  for  "To:",  "Cc:",  and "Bcc:"
          lines, and send to everyone listed in those lists.
          The "Bcc:" line will be  deleted  before  sending.
          Any  addresses  in  the  argument  vector  will be
          deleted from the send list.

-U        This option is required when  sending  mail  using
          UTF-8;  it sets the "SMTPUTF8" argument for "MAIL"
          command.  Only available if "EAI" support  is  en-
          abled, and the "SMTPUTF8" option is set.

-V envid  The indicated envid is passed with the envelope of
          the message and returned if the message bounces.

-X logfile
          Log  all traffic in and out of sendmail in the in-
          dicated logfile  for  debugging  mailer  problems.
          This  produces  a  lot  of  data  very quickly and
          should be used sparingly.

     There are a number of options that may be specified  as
primitive  flags.   These  are  the  e, i, m, and v options.
Also, the f option may be specified as the -s flag.  The DSN
related options "-N", "-R", and  "-V"  have  no  effects  on
sendmail running as daemon.

















                         Appendix B


                     QUEUE FILE FORMATS




     This  appendix describes the format of the queue files.
These files live in a queue directory.  The  individual  qf,
hf, Qf, df, and xf files may be stored in separate qf/, df/,
and  xf/ subdirectories if they are present in the queue di-
rectory.

     All queue files have  the  name  ttYMDhmsNNppppp  where
YMDhmsNNppppp  is  the  id  for this message and the tt is a
type.  The individual letters in the id are:

Y    Encoded year

M    Encoded month

D    Encoded day

h    Encoded hour

m    Encoded minute

s    Encoded second

NN   Encoded envelope number

ppppp
     At least five decimal digits of the process ID

     All files with the same id collectively define one mes-
sage.  Due to the use  of  memory-buffered  files,  some  of
these files may never appear on disk.

     The types are:

qf   The  queue control file.  This file contains the infor-
     mation necessary to process the job.

hf   The same as a queue control file, but for a quarantined
     queue job.

df   The data file.  The message body (excluding the header)
     is kept in this file.  Sometimes the  df  file  is  not
     stored  in  the  same directory as the qf file; in this
     case, the qf file contains a `d' record which names the
     queue directory that contains the df file.



SMM:08-180         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide







Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-181


tf   A temporary file.  This is an image of the qf file when
     it is being rebuilt.  It should be renamed to a qf file
     very quickly.

xf   A transcript file, existing during the life of  a  ses-
     sion  showing  everything that happens during that ses-
     sion.  Sometimes the xf file must be generated before a
     queue group has been selected; in  this  case,  the  xf
     file will be stored in a directory of the default queue
     group.

Qf   A  ``lost''  queue control file.  sendmail renames a qf
     file to Qf if there is a severe (configuration) problem
     that  cannot  be  solved  without  human  intervention.
     Search  the logfile for the queue file id to figure out
     what happened.  After you resolved the problem, you can
     rename the Qf file to qf and send it again.

     The queue control file is structured  as  a  series  of
lines  each  beginning with a code letter; the file must end
with a line containing only a single dot.  The lines are  as
follows:

V    The  version  number  of the queue file format, used to
     allow new sendmail binaries to read queue files created
     by older versions.  Defaults to version zero.  Must  be
     the  first  line  of the file if present.  For 8.13 and
     later the version number is 8.

A    The information given by the  AUTH=  parameter  of  the
     SMTP  MAIL command or $f@$j if sendmail has been called
     directly.

H    A header definition.  There may be any number of  these
     lines.   The order is important: they represent the or-
     der in the final message.  These use the same syntax as
     header definitions in the configuration file.

C    The  controlling   address.    The   syntax   is   "lo-
     caluser:aliasname".  Recipient addresses following this
     line  will be flagged so that deliveries will be run as
     the localuser (a user name from the /etc/passwd  file);
     aliasname  is  the  name  of the alias that expanded to
     this address (used for printing messages).

q    The quarantine reason for quarantined queue items.

Q    The ``original recipient'',  specified  by  the  ORCPT=
     field  in  an  ESMTP transaction.  Used exclusively for
     Delivery Status Notifications.  It applies only to  the
     following `R' line.












SMM:08-182         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


r    The  ``final recipient'' used for Delivery Status Noti-
     fications.  It applies only to the following `R' line.

R    A recipient address.  This will normally be  completely
     aliased,  but  is  actually  realiased  when the job is
     processed.  There will be one line for each  recipient.
     Version  1 qf files also include a leading colon-termi-
     nated list of flags, some of which are `S' to return  a
     message  on  successful final delivery, `F' to return a
     message on failure, `D' to return a message if the mes-
     sage is delayed, `N' to suppress  returning  the  body,
     and  `P' to declare this as a ``primary'' (command line
     or SMTP-session) address.

S    The sender address.  There may only  be  one  of  these
     lines.

T    The job creation time.  This is used to compute when to
     time out the job.

P    The  current  message  priority.  This is used to order
     the queue.  Higher numbers mean lower priorities.   The
     priority changes as the message sits in the queue.  The
     initial  priority  depends on the message class and the
     size of the message.

M    A message.  This line is printed by the mailq  command,
     and  is generally used to store status information.  It
     can contain any text.

F    Flag bits, represented as one letter per flag.  Defined
     flag bits are r indicating that this is a response mes-
     sage and w indicating that a warning message  has  been
     sent  announcing that the mail has been delayed.  Other
     flag bits are: 8: the body contains  8bit  data,  b:  a
     Bcc:  header should be removed, d: the mail has RET pa-
     rameters (see RFC 1894), n: the  body  of  the  message
     should  not be returned in case of an error, s: the en-
     velope has been split.

N    The total number of delivery attempts.

K    The time (as seconds since January 1, 1970) of the last
     delivery attempt.

d    If the df file is in a different directory than the  qf
     file,  then a `d' record is present, specifying the di-
     rectory in which the df file resides.

I    The i-number of the data file; this can be used to  re-
     cover your mail queue after a disastrous disk crash.












Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-183


$    A  macro  definition.  The values of certain macros are
     passed through to the queue run phase.

B    The body type.  The remainder of the  line  is  a  text
     string  defining the body type.  If this field is miss-
     ing, the body type is assumed to be "undefined" and  no
     special  processing  is  attempted.   Legal  values are
     "7BIT" and "8BITMIME".

Z    The original envelope id (from the ESMTP  transaction).
     For Deliver Status Notifications only.

!    Information for Deliver-By SMTP extension.

     As  an  example,  the following is a queue file sent to
"eric@mammoth.Berkeley.EDU"  and   "bostic@okeeffe.CS.Berke-
ley.EDU"[1]:

    V4
    T711358135
    K904446490
    N0
    P2100941
    $_eric@localhost
    ${daemon_flags}
    Seric
    Ceric:100:1000:sendmail@vangogh.CS.Berkeley.EDU
    RPFD:eric@mammoth.Berkeley.EDU
    RPFD:bostic@okeeffe.CS.Berkeley.EDU
    H?P?Return-path: <^g>
    H??Received: by vangogh.CS.Berkeley.EDU (5.108/2.7) id AAA06703;
        Fri, 17 Jul 1992 00:28:55 -0700
    H??Received: from mail.CS.Berkeley.EDU by vangogh.CS.Berkeley.EDU (5.108/2.7)
        id AAA06698; Fri, 17 Jul 1992 00:28:54 -0700
    H??Received: from [128.32.31.21] by mail.CS.Berkeley.EDU (5.96/2.5)
        id AA22777; Fri, 17 Jul 1992 03:29:14 -0400
    H??Received: by foo.bar.baz.de (5.57/Ultrix3.0-C)
        id AA22757; Fri, 17 Jul 1992 09:31:25 GMT
    H?F?From: eric@foo.bar.baz.de (Eric Allman)
    H?x?Full-name: Eric Allman
    H??Message-id: <9207170931.AA22757@foo.bar.baz.de>
    H??To: sendmail@vangogh.CS.Berkeley.EDU
    H??Subject: this is an example message
    .

This  shows  the person who sent the message, the submission
time  (in  seconds  since  January  1,  1970),  the  message
____________________
   [1]This  example is contrived and probably inaccurate for
your environment.  Glance over it to get  an  idea;  nothing
can replace looking at what your own system generates.












SMM:08-184         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


priority, the message class, the recipients, and the headers
for the message.
































































                         Appendix C


                  SUMMARY OF SUPPORT FILES




     This  is  a  summary of the support files that sendmail
creates or generates.  Many of these can be changed by edit-
ing the sendmail.cf file; check there  to  find  the  actual
pathnames.

/usr/sbin/sendmail
          The binary of sendmail.

/usr/bin/newaliases
          A  link  to  /usr/sbin/sendmail;  causes the alias
          database to be rebuilt.  Running this  program  is
          completely  equivalent  to giving sendmail the -bi
          flag.

/usr/bin/mailq
          Prints a listing of the mail queue.  This  program
          is equivalent to using the -bp flag to sendmail.

/etc/mail/sendmail.cf
          The configuration file, in textual form.

/etc/mail/helpfile
          The SMTP help file.

/etc/mail/statistics
          A statistics file; need not be present.

/etc/mail/sendmail.pid
          Created in daemon mode; it contains the process id
          of  the  current  SMTP daemon.  If you use this in
          scripts; use ``head -1'' to  get  just  the  first
          line;  the  second  line contains the command line
          used to invoke the daemon, and later  versions  of
          sendmail  may  add  more information to subsequent
          lines.

/etc/mail/aliases
          The textual version of the alias file.

/etc/mail/aliases.db
          The alias file in hash(3) format.

/etc/mail/aliases.{pag,dir}
          The alias file in ndbm(3) format.



Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide         SMM:08-185







SMM:08-186         Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


/var/spool/mqueue
          The directory in which the mail queue(s) and  tem-
          porary files reside.

/var/spool/mqueue/qf*
          Control (queue) files for messages.

/var/spool/mqueue/df*
          Data files.

/var/spool/mqueue/tf*
          Temporary  versions  of  the qf files, used during
          queue file rebuild.

/var/spool/mqueue/xf*
          A transcript of the current session.















































Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide           SMM:08-3


                          TABLE OF CONTENTS

1.  BASIC INSTALLATION ................................    7
   1.1.  Compiling Sendmail ...........................    7
      1.1.1.  Tweaking the Build Invocation ...........    7
      1.1.2.  Creating a Site Configuration File ......    8
      1.1.3.  Tweaking the Makefile ...................    8
      1.1.4.  Compilation and installation ............    9
   1.2.  Configuration Files ..........................   10
   1.3.  Details of Installation Files ................   12
      1.3.1.  /usr/sbin/sendmail ......................   12
      1.3.2.  /etc/mail/sendmail.cf ...................   12
      1.3.3.  /etc/mail/submit.cf .....................   13
      1.3.4.  /usr/bin/newaliases .....................   13
      1.3.5.  /usr/bin/hoststat .......................   13
      1.3.6.  /usr/bin/purgestat ......................   13
      1.3.7.  /var/spool/mqueue .......................   14
      1.3.8.  /var/spool/clientmqueue .................   14
      1.3.9.  /var/spool/mqueue/.hoststat .............   15
      1.3.10.  /etc/mail/aliases* .....................   15
      1.3.11.  /etc/rc or /etc/init.d/sendmail ........   15
      1.3.12.  /etc/mail/helpfile .....................   16
      1.3.13.  /etc/mail/statistics ...................   16
      1.3.14.  /usr/bin/mailq .........................   16
      1.3.15.  sendmail.pid ...........................   18
      1.3.16.  Map Files ..............................   18
2.  NORMAL OPERATIONS .................................   19
   2.1.  The System Log ...............................   19
      2.1.1.  Format ..................................   19
      2.1.2.  Levels ..................................   20
   2.2.  Dumping State ................................   21
   2.3.  The Mail Queues ..............................   21
      2.3.1.  Queue Groups and Queue Directories ......   21
      2.3.2.  Queue Runs ..............................   22
      2.3.3.  Manual Intervention .....................   23
      2.3.4.  Printing the queue ......................   23
      2.3.5.  Forcing the queue .......................   24
      2.3.6.  Quarantined Queue Items .................   25
   2.4.  Disk Based Connection Information ............   26
   2.5.  The Service Switch ...........................   27
   2.6.  The Alias Database ...........................   28
      2.6.1.  Rebuilding the alias database ...........   30
      2.6.2.  Potential problems ......................   30
      2.6.3.  List owners .............................   31
   2.7.  User Information Database ....................   31
   2.8.  Per-User Forwarding (.forward Files) .........   32
   2.9.  Special Header Lines .........................   32
      2.9.1.  Errors-To: ..............................   32
      2.9.2.  Apparently-To: ..........................   33
      2.9.3.  Precedence ..............................   33
   2.10.  IDENT Protocol Support ......................   33
3.  ARGUMENTS .........................................   34
   3.1.  Queue Interval ...............................   34










SMM:08-4           Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide


   3.2.  Daemon Mode ..................................   35
   3.3.  Forcing the Queue ............................   35
   3.4.  Debugging ....................................   36
   3.5.  Changing the Values of Options ...............   37
   3.6.  Trying a Different Configuration File ........   37
   3.7.  Logging Traffic ..............................   38
   3.8.  Testing Configuration Files ..................   38
   3.9.  Persistent Host Status Information ...........   40
4.  TUNING ............................................   40
   4.1.  Timeouts .....................................   41
      4.1.1.  Queue interval ..........................   41
      4.1.2.  Read timeouts ...........................   41
      4.1.3.  Message timeouts ........................   44
   4.2.  Forking During Queue Runs ....................   45
   4.3.  Queue Priorities .............................   46
   4.4.  Load Limiting ................................   47
   4.5.  Resource Limits ..............................   47
   4.6.  Measures against Denial of Service  Attacks
      .................................................   48
   4.7.  Delivery Mode ................................   48
   4.8.  Log Level ....................................   49
   4.9.  File Modes ...................................   50
      4.9.1.  To suid or not to suid?  ................   50
      4.9.2.  Turning off security checks .............   51
   4.10.  Connection Caching ..........................   55
   4.11.  Name Server Access ..........................   55
   4.12.  Moving the Per-User Forward Files ...........   57
   4.13.  Free Space ..................................   58
   4.14.  Maximum Message Size ........................   58
   4.15.  Privacy Flags ...............................   58
   4.16.  Send to Me Too ..............................   58
5.  THE WHOLE SCOOP ON THE CONFIGURATION FILE .........   59
   5.1.  R and S -- Rewriting Rules ...................   59
      5.1.1.  The left hand side ......................   60
      5.1.2.  The right hand side .....................   61
      5.1.3.  Semantics of rewriting rule sets ........   63
      5.1.4.  Ruleset hooks ...........................   64
         5.1.4.1.  check_relay ........................   65
         5.1.4.2.  check_mail .........................   65
         5.1.4.3.  check_rcpt .........................   65
         5.1.4.4.  check_data .........................   65
         5.1.4.5.  check_other ........................   65
         5.1.4.6.  check_compat .......................   66
         5.1.4.7.  check_eoh ..........................   66
         5.1.4.8.  check_eom ..........................   67
         5.1.4.9.  check_etrn .........................   67
         5.1.4.10.  check_expn ........................   67
         5.1.4.11.  check_vrfy ........................   67
         5.1.4.12.  clt_features ......................   68
         5.1.4.13.  trust_auth ........................   68
         5.1.4.14.  tls_client ........................   68
         5.1.4.15.  tls_server ........................   68
         5.1.4.16.  tls_rcpt ..........................   69










Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide           SMM:08-5


         5.1.4.17.  srv_features ......................   69
         5.1.4.18.  try_tls ...........................   71
         5.1.4.19.        tls_srv_features       and
            tls_clt_features
                 ......................................   72
         5.1.4.20.  authinfo ..........................   73
         5.1.4.21.  queuegroup ........................   73
         5.1.4.22.  greet_pause .......................   74
      5.1.5.  IPC mailers .............................   74
   5.2.  D -- Define Macro ............................   75
   5.3.  C and F -- Define Classes ....................   87
   5.4.  E -- Set or Propagate Environment Variables
      .................................................   89
   5.5.  M -- Define Mailer ...........................   89
   5.6.  H -- Define Header ...........................   98
   5.7.  O -- Set Option ..............................   99
   5.8.  P -- Precedence Definitions ..................  133
   5.9.  V -- Configuration Version Level .............  134
   5.10.  K -- Key File Declaration ...................  136
   5.11.  Q -- Queue Group Declaration ................  149
   5.12.  X -- Mail Filter (Milter) Definitions .......  151
   5.13.  The User Database ...........................  152
      5.13.1.  Structure of the user database .........  153
      5.13.2.  User database semantics ................  154
      5.13.3.  Creating the database[23] ..............  155
6.  OTHER CONFIGURATION ...............................  155
   6.1.  Parameters in devtools/OS/$oscf ..............  155
      6.1.1.  For Future Releases .....................  157
   6.2.  Parameters in sendmail/conf.h ................  157
   6.3.  Configuration in sendmail/conf.c .............  162
      6.3.1.  Built-in Header Semantics ...............  162
      6.3.2.  Restricting Use of Email ................  165
      6.3.3.  New Database Map Classes ................  166
      6.3.4.  Queueing Function .......................  166
      6.3.5.  Refusing Incoming SMTP Connections ......  167
      6.3.6.  Load Average Computation ................  167
   6.4.  Configuration in sendmail/daemon.c ...........  168
   6.5.  LDAP .........................................  168
      6.5.1.  LDAP Recursion ..........................  168
         6.5.1.1.  Example ............................  169
   6.6.  STARTTLS .....................................  170
      6.6.1.  Certificates for STARTTLS ...............  170
      6.6.2.  PRNG for STARTTLS .......................  171
   6.7.   Encoding  of  STARTTLS  and  AUTH  related
      Macros ..........................................  172
   6.8.  DANE .........................................  172
   6.9.  EAI ..........................................  173
   6.10.  MTA-STS .....................................  173
7.  ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS ..................................  174
Appendix A.  COMMAND LINE FLAGS .......................  176
Appendix B.  QUEUE FILE FORMATS .......................  180
Appendix C.  SUMMARY OF SUPPORT FILES .................  185











SMM:08-6           Sendmail Installation and Operation Guide



















                 This page intentionally left blank;
          replace it with a blank sheet for double-sided output.








































